mirror of
https://git.FreeBSD.org/src.git
synced 2024-12-27 11:55:06 +00:00
12765 lines
369 KiB
C
12765 lines
369 KiB
C
/* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from the GNU C compiler.
|
||
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
|
||
Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
||
Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
|
||
Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
|
||
Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
|
||
|
||
This file is part of GCC.
|
||
|
||
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
|
||
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
|
||
Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
|
||
version.
|
||
|
||
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
|
||
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
|
||
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
|
||
for more details.
|
||
|
||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||
along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
|
||
Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
|
||
02111-1307, USA. */
|
||
|
||
/* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
|
||
the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
|
||
out locations for types and decls.
|
||
Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
|
||
Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
|
||
|
||
/* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
|
||
information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
|
||
mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
|
||
DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
|
||
information. */
|
||
|
||
#include "config.h"
|
||
#include "system.h"
|
||
#include "tree.h"
|
||
#include "flags.h"
|
||
#include "real.h"
|
||
#include "rtl.h"
|
||
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
|
||
#include "regs.h"
|
||
#include "insn-config.h"
|
||
#include "reload.h"
|
||
#include "function.h"
|
||
#include "output.h"
|
||
#include "expr.h"
|
||
#include "libfuncs.h"
|
||
#include "except.h"
|
||
#include "dwarf2.h"
|
||
#include "dwarf2out.h"
|
||
#include "dwarf2asm.h"
|
||
#include "toplev.h"
|
||
#include "varray.h"
|
||
#include "ggc.h"
|
||
#include "md5.h"
|
||
#include "tm_p.h"
|
||
#include "diagnostic.h"
|
||
#include "debug.h"
|
||
#include "target.h"
|
||
#include "langhooks.h"
|
||
#include "hashtable.h"
|
||
#include "hashtab.h"
|
||
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
static void dwarf2out_source_line PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
|
||
CFA = Canonical Frame Address
|
||
a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
|
||
We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
|
||
The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
|
||
of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
|
||
CFI = Call Frame Instruction
|
||
an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
|
||
CIE = Common Information Entry
|
||
information describing information common to one or more FDEs
|
||
DIE = Debugging Information Entry
|
||
FDE = Frame Description Entry
|
||
information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
|
||
how to restore registers
|
||
|
||
DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
|
||
DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
|
||
|
||
/* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
|
||
translation unit. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
dwarf2out_do_frame ()
|
||
{
|
||
return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
|
||
|| write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
|
||
|| DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|
||
|| flag_unwind_tables
|
||
|| (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
|
||
#endif
|
||
);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The size of the target's pointer type. */
|
||
#ifndef PTR_SIZE
|
||
#define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Default version of targetm.eh_frame_section. Note this must appear
|
||
outside the DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO macro
|
||
guards. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
default_eh_frame_section ()
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_LD_RO_RW_SECTION_MIXING
|
||
int fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
|
||
int per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
|
||
int lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
|
||
int flags;
|
||
|
||
flags = (! flag_pic
|
||
|| ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
|
||
&& (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
|
||
&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
|
||
&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
|
||
&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
|
||
&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
|
||
? 0 : SECTION_WRITE;
|
||
named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags);
|
||
#else
|
||
named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, SECTION_WRITE);
|
||
#endif
|
||
#else
|
||
tree label = get_file_function_name ('F');
|
||
|
||
data_section ();
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
|
||
(*targetm.asm_out.globalize_label) (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
|
||
must be kept around forever. */
|
||
static GTY(()) varray_type used_rtx_varray;
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
|
||
completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a VARRAY
|
||
because we want to tell the garbage collector about it. */
|
||
static GTY(()) varray_type incomplete_types;
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
|
||
scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
|
||
of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
|
||
scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
|
||
define type declaration DIE's. */
|
||
static GTY(()) varray_type decl_scope_table;
|
||
|
||
#if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
|
||
|
||
/* How to start an assembler comment. */
|
||
#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
|
||
#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
|
||
typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
|
||
|
||
/* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
|
||
Information instructions. The register number, offset
|
||
and address fields are provided as possible operands;
|
||
their use is selected by the opcode field. */
|
||
|
||
typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long dw_cfi_reg_num;
|
||
long int dw_cfi_offset;
|
||
const char *dw_cfi_addr;
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_cfi_loc;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_cfi_oprnd;
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_cfi_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
|
||
enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
|
||
dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd1;
|
||
dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd2;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_cfi_node;
|
||
|
||
/* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
|
||
as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
|
||
It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
|
||
Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
|
||
of this structure. */
|
||
typedef struct cfa_loc
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long reg;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
long base_offset;
|
||
int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
|
||
} dw_cfa_location;
|
||
|
||
/* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
|
||
refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
|
||
the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
|
||
CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
|
||
in the DWARF generation routines below. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_fde_struct
|
||
{
|
||
const char *dw_fde_begin;
|
||
const char *dw_fde_current_label;
|
||
const char *dw_fde_end;
|
||
dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
|
||
unsigned funcdef_number;
|
||
unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
|
||
unsigned nothrow : 1;
|
||
unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_fde_node;
|
||
|
||
/* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
|
||
#define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
|
||
|
||
/* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
|
||
Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
|
||
but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
|
||
Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
|
||
pointers. */
|
||
#ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
|
||
#define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
|
||
relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
|
||
DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
|
||
as PTR_SIZE. */
|
||
|
||
#ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
|
||
#define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#define DWARF_VERSION 2
|
||
|
||
/* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
|
||
#define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
|
||
((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
|
||
|
||
/* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
|
||
#ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
#define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
|
||
#else
|
||
#define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
#endif
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
|
||
information for each routine. */
|
||
static dw_fde_ref fde_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
|
||
static unsigned fde_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned fde_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
fde_table. */
|
||
#define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
|
||
|
||
/* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
|
||
static dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
|
||
|
||
/* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
|
||
attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
|
||
with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
|
||
associated with the current function (body) definition. */
|
||
static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
|
||
|
||
struct ht *debug_str_hash;
|
||
|
||
struct indirect_string_node
|
||
{
|
||
struct ht_identifier id;
|
||
unsigned int refcount;
|
||
unsigned int form;
|
||
char *label;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
|
||
|
||
static char *stripattributes PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static const char *dwarf_cfi_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void add_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref));
|
||
static void add_fde_cfi PARAMS ((const char *, dw_cfi_ref));
|
||
static void lookup_cfa_1 PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref,
|
||
dw_cfa_location *));
|
||
static void lookup_cfa PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
|
||
static void reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, unsigned,
|
||
unsigned, long));
|
||
static void initial_return_save PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static long stack_adjust_offset PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static void output_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int));
|
||
static void output_call_frame_info PARAMS ((int));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static void queue_reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, rtx, long));
|
||
static void flush_queued_reg_saves PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr PARAMS ((rtx, const char *));
|
||
|
||
/* Support for complex CFA locations. */
|
||
static void output_cfa_loc PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref));
|
||
static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *,
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *));
|
||
static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
|
||
PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
|
||
static void def_cfa_1 PARAMS ((const char *,
|
||
dw_cfa_location *));
|
||
|
||
/* How to start an assembler comment. */
|
||
#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
|
||
#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
|
||
#define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
|
||
#define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
|
||
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
|
||
#define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
|
||
#define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
|
||
#define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
|
||
#define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
|
||
#define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
|
||
#define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
|
||
#define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
|
||
#define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
|
||
#define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
|
||
#define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
|
||
#define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
|
||
#define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
|
||
|
||
/* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
|
||
is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
|
||
registers. */
|
||
#ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
|
||
#ifdef PC_REGNUM
|
||
#define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
|
||
#else
|
||
#define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
|
||
#endif
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
|
||
default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
|
||
#ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
|
||
#define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* The offset from the incoming value of %sp to the top of the stack frame
|
||
for the current function. */
|
||
#ifndef INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
|
||
#define INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 0
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Hook used by __throw. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column ()
|
||
{
|
||
return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
|
||
attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
|
||
|
||
static inline char *
|
||
stripattributes (s)
|
||
const char *s;
|
||
{
|
||
char *stripped = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
|
||
char *p = stripped;
|
||
|
||
*p++ = '*';
|
||
|
||
while (*s && *s != ',')
|
||
*p++ = *s++;
|
||
|
||
*p = '\0';
|
||
return stripped;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (address)
|
||
tree address;
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
|
||
rtx addr = expand_expr (address, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
|
||
if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (reg_raw_mode[i]);
|
||
|
||
if (offset < 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_cfi_name (cfi_opc)
|
||
unsigned cfi_opc;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (cfi_opc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
|
||
case DW_CFA_offset:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_offset";
|
||
case DW_CFA_restore:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_restore";
|
||
case DW_CFA_nop:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_nop";
|
||
case DW_CFA_set_loc:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
|
||
case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
|
||
case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
|
||
case DW_CFA_undefined:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_undefined";
|
||
case DW_CFA_same_value:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_same_value";
|
||
case DW_CFA_register:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_register";
|
||
case DW_CFA_remember_state:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
|
||
case DW_CFA_restore_state:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
|
||
|
||
/* DWARF 3 */
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
|
||
case DW_CFA_expression:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_expression";
|
||
case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
|
||
|
||
/* SGI/MIPS specific */
|
||
case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
|
||
|
||
/* GNU extensions */
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_cfi_ref
|
||
new_cfi ()
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi = (dw_cfi_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
|
||
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
|
||
|
||
return cfi;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_cfi (list_head, cfi)
|
||
dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref *p;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the end of the chain. */
|
||
for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
*p = cfi;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
|
||
|
||
char *
|
||
dwarf2out_cfi_label ()
|
||
{
|
||
static char label[20];
|
||
static unsigned long label_num = 0;
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", label_num++);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
|
||
return label;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
|
||
or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_fde_cfi (label, cfi)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
{
|
||
if (label)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
|
||
|
||
if (*label == 0)
|
||
label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
|
||
|
||
if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
|
||
|| strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
|
||
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
|
||
|
||
/* Set the location counter to the new label. */
|
||
xcfi = new_cfi ();
|
||
xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
|
||
xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
|
||
add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else
|
||
add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc)
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
dw_cfa_location *loc;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
|
||
loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
|
||
loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
|
||
loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
|
||
loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
|
||
get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
lookup_cfa (loc)
|
||
dw_cfa_location *loc;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
|
||
loc->reg = (unsigned long) -1;
|
||
loc->offset = 0;
|
||
loc->indirect = 0;
|
||
loc->base_offset = 0;
|
||
|
||
for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
|
||
lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
|
||
|
||
if (fde_table_in_use)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
|
||
for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
|
||
lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
|
||
static dw_cfa_location cfa;
|
||
|
||
/* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
|
||
from the CFA. */
|
||
static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
|
||
|
||
/* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
|
||
static long args_size;
|
||
|
||
/* The last args_size we actually output. */
|
||
static long old_args_size;
|
||
|
||
/* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
|
||
LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
|
||
calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_def_cfa (label, reg, offset)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
unsigned reg;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfa_location loc;
|
||
loc.indirect = 0;
|
||
loc.base_offset = 0;
|
||
loc.reg = reg;
|
||
loc.offset = offset;
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
|
||
the dw_cfa_location structure. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, loc_p)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
dw_cfa_location *loc_p;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
|
||
|
||
cfa = *loc_p;
|
||
loc = *loc_p;
|
||
|
||
if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
|
||
cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
|
||
|
||
loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
|
||
lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
|
||
|
||
/* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
|
||
if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
|
||
&& loc.indirect == old_cfa.indirect
|
||
&& (loc.indirect == 0 || loc.base_offset == old_cfa.base_offset))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
cfi = new_cfi ();
|
||
|
||
if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction,
|
||
indicating the CFA register did not change but the offset
|
||
did. */
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
|
||
else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset && old_cfa.reg != (unsigned long) -1
|
||
&& !loc.indirect)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
|
||
indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
|
||
offset has not changed. */
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
else if (loc.indirect == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
|
||
indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
|
||
the specified offset. */
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
|
||
calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
|
||
register-offset pair is available. */
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
|
||
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
|
||
loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc);
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
|
||
LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
|
||
If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
|
||
otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
reg_save (label, reg, sreg, offset)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
unsigned reg;
|
||
unsigned sreg;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
|
||
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
|
||
|
||
/* The following comparison is correct. -1 is used to indicate that
|
||
the value isn't a register number. */
|
||
if (sreg == (unsigned int) -1)
|
||
{
|
||
if (reg & ~0x3f)
|
||
/* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
|
||
the long form. */
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
|
||
else
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
|
||
DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
|
||
definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
|
||
description. */
|
||
long check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
|
||
|
||
if (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT != offset)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
|
||
if (offset < 0)
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
|
||
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (sreg == reg)
|
||
/* We could emit a DW_CFA_same_value in this case, but don't bother. */
|
||
return;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
|
||
This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
|
||
from the previous frame's window save area.
|
||
|
||
??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
|
||
assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_window_save (label)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
|
||
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
|
||
add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
|
||
pushed onto the stack. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_args_size (label, size)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
long size;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
|
||
if (size == old_args_size)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
old_args_size = size;
|
||
|
||
cfi = new_cfi ();
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
|
||
add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
|
||
number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
unsigned reg;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), -1, offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
|
||
LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_return_save (label, offset)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, -1, offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
|
||
LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_return_reg (label, sreg)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
unsigned sreg;
|
||
{
|
||
reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, sreg, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
|
||
INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
initial_return_save (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int reg = (unsigned int) -1;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
/* RA is in a register. */
|
||
reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
/* RA is on the stack. */
|
||
rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
if (REGNO (rtl) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
/* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
|
||
actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
|
||
ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != CONST_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
|
||
contains. */
|
||
|
||
static long
|
||
stack_adjust_offset (pattern)
|
||
rtx pattern;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
|
||
rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
|
||
if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
|
||
code = GET_CODE (src);
|
||
if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
|
||
|| XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
if (code == PLUS)
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
/* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
|
||
src = XEXP (dest, 0);
|
||
code = GET_CODE (src);
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PRE_MODIFY:
|
||
case POST_MODIFY:
|
||
if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
|
||
/* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != PLUS ||
|
||
GET_CODE (val) != CONST_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = -INTVAL (val);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
case POST_DEC:
|
||
if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
|
||
make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
|
||
much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
|
||
insn = PATTERN (insn);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
|
||
insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
|
||
insn = SET_SRC (insn);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
|
||
save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
|
||
else if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
|
||
{
|
||
/* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
|
||
the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
|
||
doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
offset = -args_size;
|
||
#else
|
||
offset = args_size;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
|
||
offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
|
||
|| GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
|
||
{
|
||
/* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
|
||
for them. */
|
||
for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
|
||
offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (offset == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
cfa.offset += offset;
|
||
|
||
#ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
args_size += offset;
|
||
if (args_size < 0)
|
||
args_size = 0;
|
||
|
||
label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
|
||
dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
|
||
of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
|
||
register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
|
||
|
||
struct queued_reg_save
|
||
{
|
||
struct queued_reg_save *next;
|
||
rtx reg;
|
||
long cfa_offset;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
|
||
static const char *last_reg_save_label;
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
queue_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
rtx reg;
|
||
long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
struct queued_reg_save *q = (struct queued_reg_save *) xmalloc (sizeof (*q));
|
||
|
||
q->next = queued_reg_saves;
|
||
q->reg = reg;
|
||
q->cfa_offset = offset;
|
||
queued_reg_saves = q;
|
||
|
||
last_reg_save_label = label;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
flush_queued_reg_saves ()
|
||
{
|
||
struct queued_reg_save *q, *next;
|
||
|
||
for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = next)
|
||
{
|
||
dwarf2out_reg_save (last_reg_save_label, REGNO (q->reg), q->cfa_offset);
|
||
next = q->next;
|
||
free (q);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
queued_reg_saves = NULL;
|
||
last_reg_save_label = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
{
|
||
struct queued_reg_save *q;
|
||
|
||
for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
|
||
if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
|
||
return true;
|
||
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
|
||
or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
|
||
value, not an offset. */
|
||
static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
|
||
|
||
/* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
|
||
which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
|
||
address) or saves a register to the stack. LABEL indicates the
|
||
address of EXPR.
|
||
|
||
This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
|
||
cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
|
||
users need not read the source code.
|
||
|
||
The High-Level Picture
|
||
|
||
Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
|
||
assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
|
||
should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
|
||
work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
|
||
enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
|
||
|
||
Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
|
||
This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
|
||
copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
|
||
then the new register is the one we will be using for register
|
||
saves. This also seems to work.
|
||
|
||
Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
|
||
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
|
||
register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
|
||
had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
|
||
|
||
Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
|
||
offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
|
||
use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
|
||
the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
|
||
|
||
Invariants / Summaries of Rules
|
||
|
||
cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
|
||
consists of a register and an offset.
|
||
cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
|
||
cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
|
||
cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
|
||
cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
|
||
stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
|
||
stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
|
||
to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
|
||
|
||
Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
|
||
with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
|
||
cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
|
||
cfa_temp.offset.
|
||
|
||
Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
|
||
expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
|
||
and cfa_temp.offset.
|
||
|
||
Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
|
||
stack.
|
||
|
||
Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
|
||
difference of the original location and cfa_store's
|
||
location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
|
||
|
||
The Rules
|
||
|
||
"{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
|
||
"<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
|
||
|
||
Rule 1:
|
||
(set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa.offset unchanged
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 2:
|
||
(set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
|
||
{<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
|
||
cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
|
||
cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
|
||
if cfa_store.reg==sp
|
||
|
||
Rule 3:
|
||
(set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = fp
|
||
cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
|
||
|
||
Rule 4:
|
||
(set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
|
||
constraints: <reg1> != fp
|
||
<reg1> != sp
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 5:
|
||
(set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
|
||
constraints: <reg1> != fp
|
||
<reg1> != sp
|
||
effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 6:
|
||
(set <reg> <const_int>)
|
||
effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
|
||
|
||
Rule 7:
|
||
(set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
|
||
effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
|
||
|
||
Rule 8:
|
||
(set <reg> (high <exp>))
|
||
effects: none
|
||
|
||
Rule 9:
|
||
(set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
|
||
effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
|
||
|
||
Rule 10:
|
||
(set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
|
||
effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
|
||
cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
|
||
cfa.reg = sp
|
||
cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 11:
|
||
(set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
|
||
effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
|
||
cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
|
||
cfa.reg = sp
|
||
cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 12:
|
||
(set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
|
||
|
||
<reg2>)
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 13:
|
||
(set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
|
||
|
||
Rule 14:
|
||
(set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
|
||
effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
|
||
cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
|
||
cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem) */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (expr, label)
|
||
rtx expr;
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx src, dest;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
|
||
/* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
|
||
the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
|
||
it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
|
||
are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
|
||
flag is set in them. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
|
||
{
|
||
int par_index;
|
||
int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
|
||
|
||
for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
|
||
&& (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
|
||
|| par_index == 0))
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
src = SET_SRC (expr);
|
||
dest = SET_DEST (expr);
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (dest))
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
/* Rule 1 */
|
||
/* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
|
||
relative to the current CFA register. */
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (src))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Setting FP from SP. */
|
||
case REG:
|
||
if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
|
||
/* OK. */
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
|
||
ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
|
||
FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
|
||
RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
|
||
cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
case LO_SUM:
|
||
if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Rule 2 */
|
||
/* Adjusting SP. */
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
|
||
{
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
break;
|
||
case REG:
|
||
if ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1)) != cfa_temp.reg)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = cfa_temp.offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
|
||
if (cfa.reg != (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
|
||
/* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
|
||
;
|
||
else if (XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
cfa.offset += offset;
|
||
if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
cfa_store.offset += offset;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Rule 3 */
|
||
/* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
|
||
or adjusting the FP */
|
||
if (! frame_pointer_needed)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
cfa.offset += offset;
|
||
cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) == MINUS)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 4 */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
|
||
into the FP later on. */
|
||
offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
cfa.offset += offset;
|
||
cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
/* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 5 */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
|
||
&& XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
|
||
of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
|
||
if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 9 */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 6 */
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 7 */
|
||
case IOR:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) != REG
|
||
|| (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) != cfa_temp.reg
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
|
||
cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
|
||
which will fill in all of the bits. */
|
||
/* Rule 8 */
|
||
case HIGH:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (src) != REG)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
|
||
CFA register. */
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Rule 10 */
|
||
/* With a push. */
|
||
case PRE_MODIFY:
|
||
/* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1)) != CONST_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
cfa_store.offset += offset;
|
||
if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
|
||
|
||
offset = -cfa_store.offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 11 */
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
cfa_store.offset += offset;
|
||
if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
|
||
cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
|
||
|
||
offset = -cfa_store.offset;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 12 */
|
||
/* With an offset. */
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
case MINUS:
|
||
case LO_SUM:
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) != CONST_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
|
||
offset = -offset;
|
||
|
||
if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
|
||
offset -= cfa_store.offset;
|
||
else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
|
||
offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 13 */
|
||
/* Without an offset. */
|
||
case REG:
|
||
if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
|
||
offset = -cfa_store.offset;
|
||
else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
|
||
offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Rule 14 */
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
if (cfa_temp.reg != (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
|
||
cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
&& (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
|
||
|
||
if (cfa.offset == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
|
||
we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
|
||
on the ARM. */
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
|
||
queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
|
||
calculate the CFA. */
|
||
rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
|
||
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
|
||
cfa.base_offset = offset;
|
||
cfa.indirect = 1;
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
|
||
queue_reg_save (label, src, offset);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
|
||
sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
|
||
register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_debug (insn)
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
{
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
rtx src;
|
||
|
||
if (insn == NULL_RTX)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Flush any queued register saves. */
|
||
flush_queued_reg_saves ();
|
||
|
||
/* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
|
||
lookup_cfa (&cfa);
|
||
if (cfa.reg != (unsigned long) DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
|
||
cfa_store = cfa;
|
||
cfa_temp.reg = -1;
|
||
cfa_temp.offset = 0;
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
|
||
flush_queued_reg_saves ();
|
||
|
||
if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
|
||
dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn);
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
|
||
src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (src)
|
||
insn = XEXP (src, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
insn = PATTERN (insn);
|
||
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh)
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde;
|
||
int for_eh;
|
||
{
|
||
if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
|
||
| (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
|
||
"DW_CFA_advance_loc 0x%lx",
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
|
||
else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
|
||
| (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
|
||
"DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx",
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
|
||
| (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
|
||
"DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx",
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
|
||
"%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
|
||
|
||
switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_CFA_set_loc:
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
|
||
ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
|
||
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
|
||
NULL);
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
|
||
cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
|
||
case DW_CFA_undefined:
|
||
case DW_CFA_same_value:
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_register:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
|
||
case DW_CFA_expression:
|
||
output_cfa_loc (cfi);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
|
||
/* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the call frame information used to used to record information
|
||
that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
|
||
location of saved registers. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_call_frame_info (for_eh)
|
||
int for_eh;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int i;
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde;
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
|
||
bool any_lsda_needed = false;
|
||
char augmentation[6];
|
||
int augmentation_size;
|
||
int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
|
||
int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
|
||
int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
|
||
if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
|
||
emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
|
||
enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
|
||
asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
{
|
||
bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
|
||
any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
|
||
else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow)
|
||
any_eh_needed = true;
|
||
|
||
if (! any_eh_needed)
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
|
||
if (flag_debug_asm)
|
||
app_enable ();
|
||
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
(*targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section) ();
|
||
else
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
|
||
|
||
/* Output the CIE. */
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
|
||
"Length of Common Information Entry");
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
|
||
|
||
/* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
|
||
use 0 to identify the CIE. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
|
||
(for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
|
||
"CIE Identifier Tag");
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
|
||
|
||
augmentation[0] = 0;
|
||
augmentation_size = 0;
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
{
|
||
char *p;
|
||
|
||
/* Augmentation:
|
||
z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
|
||
augmentation section.
|
||
L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
|
||
an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
|
||
R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
|
||
FDE code pointers.
|
||
P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
|
||
personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
|
||
|
||
fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
|
||
per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
|
||
lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
|
||
|
||
p = augmentation + 1;
|
||
if (eh_personality_libfunc)
|
||
{
|
||
*p++ = 'P';
|
||
augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
|
||
}
|
||
if (any_lsda_needed)
|
||
{
|
||
*p++ = 'L';
|
||
augmentation_size += 1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
|
||
{
|
||
*p++ = 'R';
|
||
augmentation_size += 1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (p > augmentation + 1)
|
||
{
|
||
augmentation[0] = 'z';
|
||
*p = '\0';
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
|
||
if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
|
||
{
|
||
int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
|
||
+ 4 /* CIE Id */
|
||
+ 1 /* CIE version */
|
||
+ strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
|
||
+ size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
|
||
+ size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
|
||
+ 1 /* RA column */
|
||
+ 1 /* Augmentation size */
|
||
+ 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
|
||
int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
|
||
|
||
augmentation_size += pad;
|
||
|
||
/* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
|
||
iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
|
||
if (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) != 1)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
|
||
"CIE Data Alignment Factor");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, "CIE RA Column");
|
||
|
||
if (augmentation[0])
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
|
||
if (eh_personality_libfunc)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
|
||
eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
|
||
dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
|
||
eh_personality_libfunc, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (any_lsda_needed)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
|
||
eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
|
||
|
||
if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
|
||
eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
|
||
output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
|
||
|
||
/* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
|
||
floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
|
||
|
||
/* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
fde = &fde_table[i];
|
||
|
||
/* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
|
||
if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
|
||
&& (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
|
||
&& !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
|
||
"FDE Length");
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
|
||
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
|
||
"FDE CIE offset");
|
||
|
||
if (for_eh)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
|
||
gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin),
|
||
"FDE initial location");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
|
||
fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
|
||
"FDE address range");
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
|
||
"FDE initial location");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
|
||
fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
|
||
"FDE address range");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (augmentation[0])
|
||
{
|
||
if (any_lsda_needed)
|
||
{
|
||
int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
|
||
|
||
if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
|
||
{
|
||
int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
|
||
+ 4 /* CIE offset */
|
||
+ 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
|
||
+ 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
|
||
int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
|
||
|
||
size += pad;
|
||
if (size_of_uleb128 (size) != 1)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
|
||
|
||
if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
|
||
{
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
|
||
fde->funcdef_number);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
|
||
lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
|
||
"Language Specific Data Area");
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data
|
||
(size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
|
||
"Language Specific Data Area (none)");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
|
||
this FDE. */
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
|
||
for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
|
||
output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
|
||
|
||
/* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
|
||
floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
|
||
get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
|
||
if (flag_debug_asm)
|
||
app_disable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
|
||
the prologue. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_begin_prologue (line, file)
|
||
unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde;
|
||
|
||
current_function_func_begin_label = 0;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
|
||
/* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
|
||
for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
|
||
be used. */
|
||
if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
|
||
&& ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
|
||
return;
|
||
#else
|
||
if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
|
||
return;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
function_section (current_function_decl);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
|
||
current_function_funcdef_no);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
|
||
current_function_funcdef_no);
|
||
current_function_func_begin_label = get_identifier (label);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
|
||
/* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
|
||
if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
|
||
return;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
|
||
if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
fde_table
|
||
= (dw_fde_ref) xrealloc (fde_table,
|
||
fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
|
||
current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
|
||
fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
|
||
fde->dw_fde_begin = xstrdup (label);
|
||
fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
|
||
fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
|
||
fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
|
||
fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
|
||
fde->nothrow = current_function_nothrow;
|
||
fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
|
||
fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
|
||
|
||
args_size = old_args_size = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
|
||
prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
if (file)
|
||
dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
|
||
for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
|
||
been generated. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_end_epilogue (line, file)
|
||
unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_fde_ref fde;
|
||
char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
/* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
|
||
function. */
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
|
||
current_function_funcdef_no);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
|
||
fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
|
||
fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_init ()
|
||
{
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
|
||
fde_table = (dw_fde_ref) xcalloc (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_fde_node));
|
||
fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
fde_table_in_use = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
|
||
sake of lookup_cfa. */
|
||
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
|
||
/* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
|
||
dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
|
||
initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_frame_finish ()
|
||
{
|
||
/* Output call frame information. */
|
||
if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
|
||
output_call_frame_info (0);
|
||
|
||
if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
|
||
output_call_frame_info (1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
|
||
for emitting location expressions. */
|
||
|
||
/* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
|
||
relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
|
||
#define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
|
||
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
|
||
typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
|
||
|
||
/* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
|
||
can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
|
||
implementation are listed below. */
|
||
|
||
typedef enum
|
||
{
|
||
dw_val_class_addr,
|
||
dw_val_class_offset,
|
||
dw_val_class_loc,
|
||
dw_val_class_loc_list,
|
||
dw_val_class_range_list,
|
||
dw_val_class_const,
|
||
dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
|
||
dw_val_class_long_long,
|
||
dw_val_class_float,
|
||
dw_val_class_flag,
|
||
dw_val_class_die_ref,
|
||
dw_val_class_fde_ref,
|
||
dw_val_class_lbl_id,
|
||
dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
|
||
dw_val_class_str
|
||
}
|
||
dw_val_class;
|
||
|
||
/* Describe a double word constant value. */
|
||
/* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_long_long_struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long hi;
|
||
unsigned long low;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_long_long_const;
|
||
|
||
/* Describe a floating point constant value. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_fp_struct
|
||
{
|
||
long *array;
|
||
unsigned length;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_float_const;
|
||
|
||
/* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
|
||
represented internally. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_val_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_val_class val_class;
|
||
union
|
||
{
|
||
rtx val_addr;
|
||
long unsigned val_offset;
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref val_loc_list;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref val_loc;
|
||
long int val_int;
|
||
long unsigned val_unsigned;
|
||
dw_long_long_const val_long_long;
|
||
dw_float_const val_float;
|
||
struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
int external;
|
||
} val_die_ref;
|
||
unsigned val_fde_index;
|
||
struct indirect_string_node *val_str;
|
||
char *val_lbl_id;
|
||
unsigned char val_flag;
|
||
}
|
||
v;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_val_node;
|
||
|
||
/* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
|
||
operations. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
|
||
dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
|
||
dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
|
||
int dw_loc_addr;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_loc_descr_node;
|
||
|
||
/* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
|
||
so you can track variables that are in different places over
|
||
their entire life. */
|
||
typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
|
||
const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
|
||
const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
|
||
char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
|
||
Only on head of list */
|
||
const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
|
||
} dw_loc_list_node;
|
||
|
||
static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr PARAMS ((enum dwarf_location_atom,
|
||
unsigned long,
|
||
unsigned long));
|
||
static void add_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref *,
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static unsigned long size_of_locs PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static void output_loc_operands PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static void output_loc_sequence PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_stack_op_name (op)
|
||
unsigned op;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (op)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_OP_addr:
|
||
case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
|
||
return "DW_OP_addr";
|
||
case DW_OP_deref:
|
||
return "DW_OP_deref";
|
||
case DW_OP_const1u:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const1u";
|
||
case DW_OP_const1s:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const1s";
|
||
case DW_OP_const2u:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const2u";
|
||
case DW_OP_const2s:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const2s";
|
||
case DW_OP_const4u:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const4u";
|
||
case DW_OP_const4s:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const4s";
|
||
case DW_OP_const8u:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const8u";
|
||
case DW_OP_const8s:
|
||
return "DW_OP_const8s";
|
||
case DW_OP_constu:
|
||
return "DW_OP_constu";
|
||
case DW_OP_consts:
|
||
return "DW_OP_consts";
|
||
case DW_OP_dup:
|
||
return "DW_OP_dup";
|
||
case DW_OP_drop:
|
||
return "DW_OP_drop";
|
||
case DW_OP_over:
|
||
return "DW_OP_over";
|
||
case DW_OP_pick:
|
||
return "DW_OP_pick";
|
||
case DW_OP_swap:
|
||
return "DW_OP_swap";
|
||
case DW_OP_rot:
|
||
return "DW_OP_rot";
|
||
case DW_OP_xderef:
|
||
return "DW_OP_xderef";
|
||
case DW_OP_abs:
|
||
return "DW_OP_abs";
|
||
case DW_OP_and:
|
||
return "DW_OP_and";
|
||
case DW_OP_div:
|
||
return "DW_OP_div";
|
||
case DW_OP_minus:
|
||
return "DW_OP_minus";
|
||
case DW_OP_mod:
|
||
return "DW_OP_mod";
|
||
case DW_OP_mul:
|
||
return "DW_OP_mul";
|
||
case DW_OP_neg:
|
||
return "DW_OP_neg";
|
||
case DW_OP_not:
|
||
return "DW_OP_not";
|
||
case DW_OP_or:
|
||
return "DW_OP_or";
|
||
case DW_OP_plus:
|
||
return "DW_OP_plus";
|
||
case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
|
||
return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
|
||
case DW_OP_shl:
|
||
return "DW_OP_shl";
|
||
case DW_OP_shr:
|
||
return "DW_OP_shr";
|
||
case DW_OP_shra:
|
||
return "DW_OP_shra";
|
||
case DW_OP_xor:
|
||
return "DW_OP_xor";
|
||
case DW_OP_bra:
|
||
return "DW_OP_bra";
|
||
case DW_OP_eq:
|
||
return "DW_OP_eq";
|
||
case DW_OP_ge:
|
||
return "DW_OP_ge";
|
||
case DW_OP_gt:
|
||
return "DW_OP_gt";
|
||
case DW_OP_le:
|
||
return "DW_OP_le";
|
||
case DW_OP_lt:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lt";
|
||
case DW_OP_ne:
|
||
return "DW_OP_ne";
|
||
case DW_OP_skip:
|
||
return "DW_OP_skip";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit0:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit0";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit1:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit1";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit2:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit2";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit3:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit3";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit4:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit4";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit5:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit5";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit6:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit6";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit7:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit7";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit8:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit8";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit9:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit9";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit10:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit10";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit11:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit11";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit12:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit12";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit13:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit13";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit14:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit14";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit15:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit15";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit16:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit16";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit17:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit17";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit18:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit18";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit19:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit19";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit20:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit20";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit21:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit21";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit22:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit22";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit23:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit23";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit24:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit24";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit25:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit25";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit26:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit26";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit27:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit27";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit28:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit28";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit29:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit29";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit30:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit30";
|
||
case DW_OP_lit31:
|
||
return "DW_OP_lit31";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg0:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg0";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg1:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg1";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg2:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg2";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg3:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg3";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg4:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg4";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg5:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg5";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg6:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg6";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg7:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg7";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg8:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg8";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg9:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg9";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg10:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg10";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg11:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg11";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg12:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg12";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg13:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg13";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg14:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg14";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg15:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg15";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg16:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg16";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg17:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg17";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg18:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg18";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg19:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg19";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg20:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg20";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg21:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg21";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg22:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg22";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg23:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg23";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg24:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg24";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg25:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg25";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg26:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg26";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg27:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg27";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg28:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg28";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg29:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg29";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg30:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg30";
|
||
case DW_OP_reg31:
|
||
return "DW_OP_reg31";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg0:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg0";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg1:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg1";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg2:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg2";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg3:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg3";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg4:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg4";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg5:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg5";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg6:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg6";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg7:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg7";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg8:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg8";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg9:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg9";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg10:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg10";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg11:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg11";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg12:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg12";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg13:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg13";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg14:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg14";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg15:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg15";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg16:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg16";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg17:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg17";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg18:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg18";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg19:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg19";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg20:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg20";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg21:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg21";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg22:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg22";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg23:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg23";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg24:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg24";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg25:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg25";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg26:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg26";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg27:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg27";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg28:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg28";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg29:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg29";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg30:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg30";
|
||
case DW_OP_breg31:
|
||
return "DW_OP_breg31";
|
||
case DW_OP_regx:
|
||
return "DW_OP_regx";
|
||
case DW_OP_fbreg:
|
||
return "DW_OP_fbreg";
|
||
case DW_OP_bregx:
|
||
return "DW_OP_bregx";
|
||
case DW_OP_piece:
|
||
return "DW_OP_piece";
|
||
case DW_OP_deref_size:
|
||
return "DW_OP_deref_size";
|
||
case DW_OP_xderef_size:
|
||
return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
|
||
case DW_OP_nop:
|
||
return "DW_OP_nop";
|
||
case DW_OP_push_object_address:
|
||
return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
|
||
case DW_OP_call2:
|
||
return "DW_OP_call2";
|
||
case DW_OP_call4:
|
||
return "DW_OP_call4";
|
||
case DW_OP_call_ref:
|
||
return "DW_OP_call_ref";
|
||
case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
|
||
return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
|
||
default:
|
||
return "OP_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
|
||
descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
|
||
together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
new_loc_descr (op, oprnd1, oprnd2)
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom op;
|
||
unsigned long oprnd1;
|
||
unsigned long oprnd2;
|
||
{
|
||
/* Use xcalloc here so we clear out all of the long_long constant in
|
||
the union. */
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref descr
|
||
= (dw_loc_descr_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
|
||
|
||
descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
|
||
descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
|
||
descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
|
||
descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
|
||
descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
|
||
|
||
return descr;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_loc_descr (list_head, descr)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the end of the chain. */
|
||
for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
*d = descr;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned long
|
||
size_of_loc_descr (loc)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size = 1;
|
||
|
||
switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_OP_addr:
|
||
case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
|
||
size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const1u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const1s:
|
||
size += 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const2u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const2s:
|
||
size += 2;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const4u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const4s:
|
||
size += 4;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const8u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const8s:
|
||
size += 8;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_constu:
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_consts:
|
||
size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_pick:
|
||
size += 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_skip:
|
||
case DW_OP_bra:
|
||
size += 2;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_breg0:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg1:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg2:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg3:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg4:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg5:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg6:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg7:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg8:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg9:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg10:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg11:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg12:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg13:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg14:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg15:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg16:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg17:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg18:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg19:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg20:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg21:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg22:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg23:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg24:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg25:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg26:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg27:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg28:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg29:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg30:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg31:
|
||
size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_regx:
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_fbreg:
|
||
size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_bregx:
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_piece:
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_deref_size:
|
||
case DW_OP_xderef_size:
|
||
size += 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_call2:
|
||
size += 2;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_call4:
|
||
size += 4;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_call_ref:
|
||
size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return size;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned long
|
||
size_of_locs (loc)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
|
||
for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
|
||
{
|
||
loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
|
||
size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return size;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_loc_operands (loc)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
|
||
dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
|
||
|
||
switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
case DW_OP_addr:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const2u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const2s:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const4u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const4s:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_const8u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const8s:
|
||
if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG < 64)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_skip:
|
||
case DW_OP_bra:
|
||
{
|
||
int offset;
|
||
|
||
if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
|
||
offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
#else
|
||
case DW_OP_addr:
|
||
case DW_OP_const2u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const2s:
|
||
case DW_OP_const4u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const4s:
|
||
case DW_OP_const8u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const8s:
|
||
case DW_OP_skip:
|
||
case DW_OP_bra:
|
||
/* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
|
||
aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
|
||
don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
|
||
only doing unwinding. */
|
||
abort ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
case DW_OP_const1u:
|
||
case DW_OP_const1s:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_constu:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_consts:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_pick:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_breg0:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg1:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg2:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg3:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg4:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg5:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg6:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg7:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg8:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg9:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg10:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg11:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg12:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg13:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg14:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg15:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg16:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg17:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg18:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg19:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg20:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg21:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg22:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg23:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg24:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg25:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg26:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg27:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg28:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg29:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg30:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg31:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_regx:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_fbreg:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_bregx:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_piece:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_deref_size:
|
||
case DW_OP_xderef_size:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
|
||
#ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (asm_out_file, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
|
||
val1->v.val_addr);
|
||
fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
|
||
#else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
/* Other codes have no operands. */
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a sequence of location operations. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_loc_sequence (loc)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
{
|
||
for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Output the opcode. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
|
||
"%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
|
||
|
||
/* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
|
||
output_loc_operands (loc);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
|
||
description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_cfa_loc (cfi)
|
||
dw_cfi_ref cfi;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
|
||
/* Output the size of the block. */
|
||
loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
|
||
size = size_of_locs (loc);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Now output the operations themselves. */
|
||
output_loc_sequence (loc);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from
|
||
a dw_cfa_location. */
|
||
|
||
static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
|
||
build_cfa_loc (cfa)
|
||
dw_cfa_location *cfa;
|
||
{
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
|
||
|
||
if (cfa->indirect == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (cfa->base_offset)
|
||
{
|
||
if (cfa->reg <= 31)
|
||
head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
|
||
head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
|
||
|
||
head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
|
||
if (cfa->offset != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, cfa->offset, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return head;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
|
||
descriptor sequence. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
get_cfa_from_loc_descr (cfa, loc)
|
||
dw_cfa_location *cfa;
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc;
|
||
{
|
||
struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
|
||
cfa->offset = 0;
|
||
cfa->base_offset = 0;
|
||
cfa->indirect = 0;
|
||
cfa->reg = -1;
|
||
|
||
for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
|
||
|
||
switch (op)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_OP_reg0:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg1:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg2:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg3:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg4:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg5:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg6:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg7:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg8:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg9:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg10:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg11:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg12:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg13:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg14:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg15:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg16:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg17:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg18:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg19:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg20:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg21:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg22:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg23:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg24:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg25:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg26:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg27:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg28:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg29:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg30:
|
||
case DW_OP_reg31:
|
||
cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_regx:
|
||
cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_breg0:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg1:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg2:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg3:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg4:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg5:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg6:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg7:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg8:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg9:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg10:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg11:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg12:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg13:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg14:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg15:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg16:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg17:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg18:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg19:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg20:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg21:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg22:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg23:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg24:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg25:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg26:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg27:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg28:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg29:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg30:
|
||
case DW_OP_breg31:
|
||
cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
|
||
cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_bregx:
|
||
cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
|
||
cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_deref:
|
||
cfa->indirect = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
|
||
cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented\n",
|
||
dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif /* .debug_frame support */
|
||
|
||
/* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
|
||
#ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
|
||
/* .debug_str support. */
|
||
static hashnode indirect_string_alloc PARAMS ((hash_table *));
|
||
static int output_indirect_string PARAMS ((struct cpp_reader *,
|
||
hashnode, const PTR));
|
||
|
||
|
||
static void dwarf2out_init PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_finish PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_define PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_undef PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_start_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned, const char *));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_end_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_begin_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_end_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
|
||
static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_global_decl PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void dwarf2out_abstract_function PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
|
||
/* The debug hooks structure. */
|
||
|
||
const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
|
||
{
|
||
dwarf2out_init,
|
||
dwarf2out_finish,
|
||
dwarf2out_define,
|
||
dwarf2out_undef,
|
||
dwarf2out_start_source_file,
|
||
dwarf2out_end_source_file,
|
||
dwarf2out_begin_block,
|
||
dwarf2out_end_block,
|
||
dwarf2out_ignore_block,
|
||
dwarf2out_source_line,
|
||
dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
|
||
debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
|
||
dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
|
||
debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
|
||
debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
|
||
dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
|
||
dwarf2out_global_decl,
|
||
debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
|
||
/* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
|
||
emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
|
||
something tries to reference them. */
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
|
||
debug_nothing_rtx /* label */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
|
||
"Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
|
||
throughout the remainder of this file. */
|
||
|
||
/* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
|
||
walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
|
||
representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
|
||
The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
|
||
|
||
/* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
|
||
.debug_info section to refer to each other. */
|
||
|
||
typedef long int dw_offset;
|
||
|
||
/* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
|
||
typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
|
||
typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
|
||
|
||
/* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
|
||
line number associated with the label generated for that
|
||
entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
|
||
the line number entry. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_line_info_struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long dw_file_num;
|
||
unsigned long dw_line_num;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_line_info_entry;
|
||
|
||
/* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
|
||
own sequence. */
|
||
typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long dw_file_num;
|
||
unsigned long dw_line_num;
|
||
unsigned long function;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_separate_line_info_entry;
|
||
|
||
/* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
|
||
a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
|
||
Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct dw_attr_struct
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
|
||
dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
|
||
dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
|
||
}
|
||
dw_attr_node;
|
||
|
||
/* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct die_struct
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
|
||
char *die_symbol;
|
||
dw_attr_ref die_attr;
|
||
dw_die_ref die_parent;
|
||
dw_die_ref die_child;
|
||
dw_die_ref die_sib;
|
||
dw_offset die_offset;
|
||
unsigned long die_abbrev;
|
||
int die_mark;
|
||
}
|
||
die_node;
|
||
|
||
/* The pubname structure */
|
||
|
||
typedef struct pubname_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
char *name;
|
||
}
|
||
pubname_entry;
|
||
|
||
struct dw_ranges_struct
|
||
{
|
||
int block_num;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* The limbo die list structure. */
|
||
typedef struct limbo_die_struct
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree created_for;
|
||
struct limbo_die_struct *next;
|
||
}
|
||
limbo_die_node;
|
||
|
||
/* How to start an assembler comment. */
|
||
#ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
|
||
#define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
|
||
implicitly generated for a tagged type.
|
||
|
||
Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
|
||
TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
|
||
each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
|
||
_named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
|
||
These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
|
||
generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
|
||
|
||
#define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
|
||
(DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
|
||
|| (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
|
||
&& is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
|
||
&& ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
|
||
/* This is necessary for stub decls that \
|
||
appear in nested inline functions. */ \
|
||
|| (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
|
||
&& (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
|
||
== TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
|
||
|
||
/* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
|
||
language, and compiler version. */
|
||
|
||
/* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
|
||
#define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
|
||
|
||
/* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
|
||
#define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
|
||
|
||
/* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
|
||
#define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
|
||
(DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
|
||
- DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
|
||
|
||
/* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
|
||
aligned to twice the pointer size. */
|
||
#define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
|
||
(DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
|
||
- (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
|
||
|
||
/* Use assembler line directives if available. */
|
||
#ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
|
||
#define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
|
||
#else
|
||
#define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
|
||
#endif
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
|
||
This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
|
||
#define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
|
||
|
||
/* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
|
||
#define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
|
||
|
||
/* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
|
||
#define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
|
||
|
||
/* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
|
||
In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
|
||
the beginning of a source statement, because that information
|
||
is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
|
||
#define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
|
||
|
||
/* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
|
||
the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
|
||
static unsigned long next_die_offset;
|
||
|
||
/* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
|
||
static dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
|
||
|
||
/* We need special handling in dwarf2out_start_source_file if it is
|
||
first one. */
|
||
static int is_main_source;
|
||
|
||
/* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
|
||
static limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Structure used by lookup_filename to manage sets of filenames. */
|
||
struct file_table
|
||
{
|
||
char **table;
|
||
unsigned allocated;
|
||
unsigned in_use;
|
||
unsigned last_lookup_index;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the filename
|
||
table. */
|
||
#define FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
|
||
|
||
/* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
|
||
static struct file_table file_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Local pointer to the name of the main input file. Initialized in
|
||
dwarf2out_init. */
|
||
static const char *primary_filename;
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table of references to DIE's that describe
|
||
declarations. The table is indexed by DECL_UID() which is a unique
|
||
number identifying each decl. */
|
||
static dw_die_ref *decl_die_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for the decl_die_table. */
|
||
static unsigned decl_die_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in decl_die_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned decl_die_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
decl_die_table. */
|
||
#define DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
|
||
are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
|
||
children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
|
||
static dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
|
||
static unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
abbrev_die_table. */
|
||
#define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
|
||
for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
|
||
static dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
|
||
static unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
|
||
for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
|
||
static dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
|
||
static unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
line_info_table. */
|
||
#define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
|
||
|
||
/* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
|
||
accessible names. */
|
||
static pubname_ref pubname_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
|
||
static unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
pubname_table. */
|
||
#define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
|
||
|
||
/* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
|
||
static dw_die_ref *arange_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
|
||
static unsigned arange_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned arange_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
arange_table. */
|
||
#define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
|
||
|
||
/* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
|
||
static dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
|
||
static unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
|
||
|
||
/* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
|
||
static unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
|
||
ranges_table. */
|
||
#define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
|
||
|
||
/* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
|
||
static unsigned have_location_lists;
|
||
|
||
/* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
|
||
static int current_function_has_inlines;
|
||
#if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
|
||
static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
|
||
|
||
static int is_pseudo_reg PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static tree type_main_variant PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static int is_tagged_type PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static const char *dwarf_tag_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
static const char *dwarf_attr_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
static const char *dwarf_form_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static const char *dwarf_type_encoding_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
|
||
#endif
|
||
static tree decl_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static tree block_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static tree decl_class_context PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void add_dwarf_attr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static inline dw_val_class AT_class PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned));
|
||
static inline unsigned AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_int PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute, long));
|
||
static inline long int AT_int PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned long));
|
||
static inline unsigned long AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_long_long PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned long,
|
||
unsigned long));
|
||
static void add_AT_float PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned, long *));
|
||
static void add_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
const char *));
|
||
static inline const char *AT_string PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static int AT_string_form PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_die_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
dw_die_ref));
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static inline int AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static inline void set_AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref, int));
|
||
static void add_AT_fde_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned));
|
||
static void add_AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref));
|
||
static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
rtx));
|
||
static inline rtx AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void add_AT_lbl_id PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
const char *));
|
||
static void add_AT_lbl_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
const char *));
|
||
static void add_AT_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned long));
|
||
static void add_AT_range_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
unsigned long));
|
||
static inline const char *AT_lbl PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static dw_attr_ref get_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static const char *get_AT_low_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static const char *get_AT_hi_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static const char *get_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static int get_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static unsigned get_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static int is_c_family PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static int is_cxx PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static int is_java PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static int is_fortran PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void remove_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute));
|
||
static inline void free_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void remove_children PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void add_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref new_die PARAMS ((enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref,
|
||
tree));
|
||
static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void equate_type_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void equate_decl_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void print_spaces PARAMS ((FILE *));
|
||
static void print_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, FILE *));
|
||
static void print_dwarf_line_table PARAMS ((FILE *));
|
||
static void reverse_die_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void reverse_all_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void loc_checksum PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
|
||
struct md5_ctx *));
|
||
static void attr_checksum PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref,
|
||
struct md5_ctx *,
|
||
int *));
|
||
static void die_checksum PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
struct md5_ctx *,
|
||
int *));
|
||
static int same_loc_p PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref, int *));
|
||
static int same_dw_val_p PARAMS ((dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *,
|
||
int *));
|
||
static int same_attr_p PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *));
|
||
static int same_die_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *));
|
||
static int same_die_p_wrap PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void compute_section_prefix PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int is_type_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int is_comdat_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int is_symbol_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void assign_symbol_names PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void break_out_includes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static hashval_t htab_cu_hash PARAMS ((const void *));
|
||
static int htab_cu_eq PARAMS ((const void *, const void *));
|
||
static void htab_cu_del PARAMS ((void *));
|
||
static int check_duplicate_cu PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *));
|
||
static void record_comdat_symbol_number PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned));
|
||
static void add_sibling_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void build_abbrev_table PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void output_location_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int constant_size PARAMS ((long unsigned));
|
||
static unsigned long size_of_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void calc_die_sizes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void mark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void unmark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void unmark_all_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static unsigned long size_of_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static unsigned long size_of_aranges PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static enum dwarf_form value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void output_value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static void output_abbrev_section PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void output_die_symbol PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void output_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void output_compilation_unit_header PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void output_comp_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, int));
|
||
static const char *dwarf2_name PARAMS ((tree, int));
|
||
static void add_pubname PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void output_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void add_arange PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void output_aranges PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static unsigned int add_ranges PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void output_ranges PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void output_line_info PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void output_file_names PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static dw_die_ref base_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static tree root_type PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static int is_base_type PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static dw_die_ref modified_type_die PARAMS ((tree, int, int, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int type_is_enum PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static unsigned int reg_number PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr PARAMS ((unsigned, long));
|
||
static int is_based_loc PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode mode));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree PARAMS ((tree, int));
|
||
static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int));
|
||
static tree field_type PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void add_AT_location_description PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute,
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref));
|
||
static void add_data_member_location_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, rtx));
|
||
static rtx rtl_for_decl_location PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void tree_add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_name_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, const char *));
|
||
static void add_bound_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute, tree));
|
||
static void add_subscript_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_byte_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_bit_offset_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_bit_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_prototyped_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_abstract_origin_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
|
||
static void push_decl_scope PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void pop_decl_scope PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static dw_die_ref scope_die_for PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static inline int local_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static inline int class_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void add_type_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree, int, int,
|
||
dw_die_ref));
|
||
static const char *type_tag PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static tree member_declared_type PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static const char *decl_start_label PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
#endif
|
||
static void gen_array_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_set_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static void gen_entry_point_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
#endif
|
||
static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_inlined_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_formal_types_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_subprogram_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_variable_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_label_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_lexical_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
|
||
static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
|
||
static void gen_field_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static void gen_string_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_inheritance_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_member_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_subroutine_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_typedef_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void gen_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
|
||
static void decls_for_scope PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
|
||
static int is_redundant_typedef PARAMS ((tree));
|
||
static void gen_decl_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static unsigned lookup_filename PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static void init_file_table PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void retry_incomplete_types PARAMS ((void));
|
||
static void gen_type_die_for_member PARAMS ((tree, tree, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static void splice_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
|
||
static int file_info_cmp PARAMS ((const void *, const void *));
|
||
static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
|
||
const char *, const char *,
|
||
const char *, unsigned));
|
||
static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref *,
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref,
|
||
const char *, const char *, const char *));
|
||
static void output_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref));
|
||
static char *gen_internal_sym PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
static void mark_limbo_die_list PARAMS ((void *));
|
||
|
||
/* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
|
||
#define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
|
||
#ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
|
||
#define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE
|
||
#define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
|
||
(SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1)
|
||
#else
|
||
#define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS SECTION_DEBUG
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
|
||
the section names themselves. */
|
||
|
||
#ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
|
||
#define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
|
||
(artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
|
||
options is used and DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
|
||
If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
|
||
typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
|
||
|
||
static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
#ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
|
||
#define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
|
||
#define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
|
||
#define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
|
||
#define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
|
||
#endif
|
||
#ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
|
||
#define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
|
||
called to "demangle" any name before it it put into a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *(*demangle_name_func) PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (func)
|
||
const char *(*func) PARAMS ((const char *));
|
||
{
|
||
demangle_name_func = func;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
return ((GET_CODE (rtl) == REG && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
|
||
&& REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
|
||
removed. */
|
||
|
||
static inline tree
|
||
type_main_variant (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
|
||
variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
|
||
members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
|
||
front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
|
||
here. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
|
||
while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
|
||
type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
|
||
|
||
return type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_tagged_type (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
|
||
|
||
return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
|
||
|| code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_tag_name (tag)
|
||
unsigned tag;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (tag)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_TAG_padding:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_padding";
|
||
case DW_TAG_array_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_array_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_class_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_class_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_entry_point:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
|
||
case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
|
||
case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
|
||
case DW_TAG_label:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_label";
|
||
case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
|
||
case DW_TAG_member:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_member";
|
||
case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_reference_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
|
||
case DW_TAG_string_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_string_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_structure_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_typedef:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_typedef";
|
||
case DW_TAG_union_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_union_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
|
||
case DW_TAG_variant:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_variant";
|
||
case DW_TAG_common_block:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_common_block";
|
||
case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
|
||
case DW_TAG_inheritance:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
|
||
case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
|
||
case DW_TAG_module:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_module";
|
||
case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_set_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_set_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
|
||
case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
|
||
case DW_TAG_base_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_base_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_catch_block:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
|
||
case DW_TAG_const_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_const_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_constant:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_constant";
|
||
case DW_TAG_enumerator:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
|
||
case DW_TAG_file_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_file_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_friend:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_friend";
|
||
case DW_TAG_namelist:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_namelist";
|
||
case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
|
||
case DW_TAG_packed_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_subprogram:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
|
||
case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
|
||
case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
|
||
case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_try_block:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_try_block";
|
||
case DW_TAG_variant_part:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
|
||
case DW_TAG_variable:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_variable";
|
||
case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
|
||
case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
|
||
case DW_TAG_format_label:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_format_label";
|
||
case DW_TAG_function_template:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_function_template";
|
||
case DW_TAG_class_template:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_class_template";
|
||
case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
|
||
case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
|
||
default:
|
||
return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_attr_name (attr)
|
||
unsigned attr;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (attr)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_AT_sibling:
|
||
return "DW_AT_sibling";
|
||
case DW_AT_location:
|
||
return "DW_AT_location";
|
||
case DW_AT_name:
|
||
return "DW_AT_name";
|
||
case DW_AT_ordering:
|
||
return "DW_AT_ordering";
|
||
case DW_AT_subscr_data:
|
||
return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
|
||
case DW_AT_byte_size:
|
||
return "DW_AT_byte_size";
|
||
case DW_AT_bit_offset:
|
||
return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
|
||
case DW_AT_bit_size:
|
||
return "DW_AT_bit_size";
|
||
case DW_AT_element_list:
|
||
return "DW_AT_element_list";
|
||
case DW_AT_stmt_list:
|
||
return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
|
||
case DW_AT_low_pc:
|
||
return "DW_AT_low_pc";
|
||
case DW_AT_high_pc:
|
||
return "DW_AT_high_pc";
|
||
case DW_AT_language:
|
||
return "DW_AT_language";
|
||
case DW_AT_member:
|
||
return "DW_AT_member";
|
||
case DW_AT_discr:
|
||
return "DW_AT_discr";
|
||
case DW_AT_discr_value:
|
||
return "DW_AT_discr_value";
|
||
case DW_AT_visibility:
|
||
return "DW_AT_visibility";
|
||
case DW_AT_import:
|
||
return "DW_AT_import";
|
||
case DW_AT_string_length:
|
||
return "DW_AT_string_length";
|
||
case DW_AT_common_reference:
|
||
return "DW_AT_common_reference";
|
||
case DW_AT_comp_dir:
|
||
return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
|
||
case DW_AT_const_value:
|
||
return "DW_AT_const_value";
|
||
case DW_AT_containing_type:
|
||
return "DW_AT_containing_type";
|
||
case DW_AT_default_value:
|
||
return "DW_AT_default_value";
|
||
case DW_AT_inline:
|
||
return "DW_AT_inline";
|
||
case DW_AT_is_optional:
|
||
return "DW_AT_is_optional";
|
||
case DW_AT_lower_bound:
|
||
return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
|
||
case DW_AT_producer:
|
||
return "DW_AT_producer";
|
||
case DW_AT_prototyped:
|
||
return "DW_AT_prototyped";
|
||
case DW_AT_return_addr:
|
||
return "DW_AT_return_addr";
|
||
case DW_AT_start_scope:
|
||
return "DW_AT_start_scope";
|
||
case DW_AT_stride_size:
|
||
return "DW_AT_stride_size";
|
||
case DW_AT_upper_bound:
|
||
return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
|
||
case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
|
||
case DW_AT_accessibility:
|
||
return "DW_AT_accessibility";
|
||
case DW_AT_address_class:
|
||
return "DW_AT_address_class";
|
||
case DW_AT_artificial:
|
||
return "DW_AT_artificial";
|
||
case DW_AT_base_types:
|
||
return "DW_AT_base_types";
|
||
case DW_AT_calling_convention:
|
||
return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
|
||
case DW_AT_count:
|
||
return "DW_AT_count";
|
||
case DW_AT_data_member_location:
|
||
return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
|
||
case DW_AT_decl_column:
|
||
return "DW_AT_decl_column";
|
||
case DW_AT_decl_file:
|
||
return "DW_AT_decl_file";
|
||
case DW_AT_decl_line:
|
||
return "DW_AT_decl_line";
|
||
case DW_AT_declaration:
|
||
return "DW_AT_declaration";
|
||
case DW_AT_discr_list:
|
||
return "DW_AT_discr_list";
|
||
case DW_AT_encoding:
|
||
return "DW_AT_encoding";
|
||
case DW_AT_external:
|
||
return "DW_AT_external";
|
||
case DW_AT_frame_base:
|
||
return "DW_AT_frame_base";
|
||
case DW_AT_friend:
|
||
return "DW_AT_friend";
|
||
case DW_AT_identifier_case:
|
||
return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
|
||
case DW_AT_macro_info:
|
||
return "DW_AT_macro_info";
|
||
case DW_AT_namelist_items:
|
||
return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
|
||
case DW_AT_priority:
|
||
return "DW_AT_priority";
|
||
case DW_AT_segment:
|
||
return "DW_AT_segment";
|
||
case DW_AT_specification:
|
||
return "DW_AT_specification";
|
||
case DW_AT_static_link:
|
||
return "DW_AT_static_link";
|
||
case DW_AT_type:
|
||
return "DW_AT_type";
|
||
case DW_AT_use_location:
|
||
return "DW_AT_use_location";
|
||
case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
|
||
return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
|
||
case DW_AT_virtuality:
|
||
return "DW_AT_virtuality";
|
||
case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
|
||
return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
|
||
|
||
case DW_AT_allocated:
|
||
return "DW_AT_allocated";
|
||
case DW_AT_associated:
|
||
return "DW_AT_associated";
|
||
case DW_AT_data_location:
|
||
return "DW_AT_data_location";
|
||
case DW_AT_stride:
|
||
return "DW_AT_stride";
|
||
case DW_AT_entry_pc:
|
||
return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
|
||
case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
|
||
return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
|
||
case DW_AT_extension:
|
||
return "DW_AT_extension";
|
||
case DW_AT_ranges:
|
||
return "DW_AT_ranges";
|
||
case DW_AT_trampoline:
|
||
return "DW_AT_trampoline";
|
||
case DW_AT_call_column:
|
||
return "DW_AT_call_column";
|
||
case DW_AT_call_file:
|
||
return "DW_AT_call_file";
|
||
case DW_AT_call_line:
|
||
return "DW_AT_call_line";
|
||
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
|
||
case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
|
||
return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
|
||
|
||
case DW_AT_sf_names:
|
||
return "DW_AT_sf_names";
|
||
case DW_AT_src_info:
|
||
return "DW_AT_src_info";
|
||
case DW_AT_mac_info:
|
||
return "DW_AT_mac_info";
|
||
case DW_AT_src_coords:
|
||
return "DW_AT_src_coords";
|
||
case DW_AT_body_begin:
|
||
return "DW_AT_body_begin";
|
||
case DW_AT_body_end:
|
||
return "DW_AT_body_end";
|
||
case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
|
||
return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
|
||
|
||
case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
|
||
return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_form_name (form)
|
||
unsigned form;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (form)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_FORM_addr:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_addr";
|
||
case DW_FORM_block2:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_block2";
|
||
case DW_FORM_block4:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_block4";
|
||
case DW_FORM_data2:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_data2";
|
||
case DW_FORM_data4:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_data4";
|
||
case DW_FORM_data8:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_data8";
|
||
case DW_FORM_string:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_string";
|
||
case DW_FORM_block:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_block";
|
||
case DW_FORM_block1:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_block1";
|
||
case DW_FORM_data1:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_data1";
|
||
case DW_FORM_flag:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_flag";
|
||
case DW_FORM_sdata:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_sdata";
|
||
case DW_FORM_strp:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_strp";
|
||
case DW_FORM_udata:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_udata";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref1:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref1";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref2:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref2";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref4:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref4";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref8:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref8";
|
||
case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
|
||
case DW_FORM_indirect:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_indirect";
|
||
default:
|
||
return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Convert a DWARF type code into its string name. */
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf_type_encoding_name (enc)
|
||
unsigned enc;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (enc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_ATE_address:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_address";
|
||
case DW_ATE_boolean:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_boolean";
|
||
case DW_ATE_complex_float:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_complex_float";
|
||
case DW_ATE_float:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_float";
|
||
case DW_ATE_signed:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_signed";
|
||
case DW_ATE_signed_char:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_signed_char";
|
||
case DW_ATE_unsigned:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_unsigned";
|
||
case DW_ATE_unsigned_char:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_unsigned_char";
|
||
default:
|
||
return "DW_ATE_<unknown>";
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
|
||
instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
|
||
function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
|
||
to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
|
||
given block. */
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
decl_ultimate_origin (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
/* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
|
||
nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
|
||
we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
|
||
if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
|
||
return NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
|
||
if (DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)))
|
||
/* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
|
||
most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
|
||
abort ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
|
||
instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
|
||
function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
|
||
to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
|
||
given block. */
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
block_ultimate_origin (block)
|
||
tree block;
|
||
{
|
||
tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
|
||
|
||
/* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
|
||
nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
|
||
we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
|
||
if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
|
||
return NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
|
||
return NULL_TREE;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
tree ret_val;
|
||
tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
|
||
|
||
do
|
||
{
|
||
ret_val = lookahead;
|
||
lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
|
||
? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
|
||
|
||
return ret_val;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
|
||
of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
|
||
parameter. */
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
decl_class_context (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
tree context = NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
|
||
context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
|
||
else
|
||
context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
|
||
(TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
|
||
|
||
if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
|
||
context = NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
return context;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
|
||
addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr;
|
||
{
|
||
if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
|
||
die->die_attr = attr;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_val_class
|
||
AT_class (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_flag (die, attr_kind, flag)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned flag;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned
|
||
AT_flag (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_int (die, attr_kind, int_val)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
long int int_val;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline long int
|
||
AT_int (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind, unsigned_val)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned long unsigned_val;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned long
|
||
AT_unsigned (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_long_long (die, attr_kind, val_hi, val_low)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned long val_hi;
|
||
unsigned long val_low;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_float (die, attr_kind, length, array)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned length;
|
||
long *array;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_float;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length = length;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array = array;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_string (die, attr_kind, str)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
const char *str;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
struct indirect_string_node *node;
|
||
|
||
if (! debug_str_hash)
|
||
{
|
||
debug_str_hash = ht_create (10);
|
||
debug_str_hash->alloc_node = indirect_string_alloc;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
|
||
ht_lookup (debug_str_hash, (const unsigned char *) str,
|
||
strlen (str), HT_ALLOC);
|
||
node->refcount++;
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline const char *
|
||
AT_string (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
|
||
return (const char *) HT_STR (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id);
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
|
||
or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
AT_string_form (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
|
||
{
|
||
struct indirect_string_node *node;
|
||
unsigned int len;
|
||
extern int const_labelno;
|
||
char label[32];
|
||
|
||
node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
|
||
if (node->form)
|
||
return node->form;
|
||
|
||
len = HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1;
|
||
|
||
/* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
|
||
always better to put it inline. */
|
||
if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
|
||
return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
|
||
|
||
/* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
|
||
section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
|
||
single module. */
|
||
if ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
|
||
&& (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
|
||
return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LC", const_labelno);
|
||
++const_labelno;
|
||
node->label = xstrdup (label);
|
||
|
||
return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
dw_die_ref targ_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref
|
||
AT_ref (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
AT_ref_external (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
set_AT_ref_external (a, i)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
int i;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_fde_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_fde)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned targ_fde;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, loc)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
AT_loc (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, loc_list)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
have_location_lists = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_loc_list_ref
|
||
AT_loc_list (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_addr (die, attr_kind, addr)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
rtx addr;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline rtx
|
||
AT_addr (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr)
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (die, attr_kind, lbl_id)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
const char *lbl_id;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_lbl_offset (die, attr_kind, label)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
const char *label;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_offset (die, attr_kind, offset)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_AT_range_list (die, attr_kind, offset)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
unsigned long offset;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
|
||
|
||
attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
|
||
attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
|
||
attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
|
||
add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline const char *
|
||
AT_lbl (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
if (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
|
||
|| AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset))
|
||
return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
|
||
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_attr_ref
|
||
get_AT (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (die != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
|
||
return a;
|
||
else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
|
||
|| a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
|
||
spec = AT_ref (a);
|
||
|
||
if (spec)
|
||
return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
|
||
DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
|
||
cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
|
||
|
||
static inline const char *
|
||
get_AT_low_pc (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
|
||
DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
|
||
cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
|
||
|
||
static inline const char *
|
||
get_AT_hi_pc (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
|
||
NULL if it is not present. */
|
||
|
||
static inline const char *
|
||
get_AT_string (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
|
||
if it is not present. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
get_AT_flag (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
|
||
if it is not present. */
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned
|
||
get_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref
|
||
get_AT_ref (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
|
||
|
||
return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_c_family ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
|
||
|
||
return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
|
||
|| lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_cxx ()
|
||
{
|
||
return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
|
||
== DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_fortran ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
|
||
|
||
return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_java ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
|
||
|
||
return (lang == DW_LANG_Java);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Free up the memory used by A. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void free_AT PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
|
||
static inline void
|
||
free_AT (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (AT_class (a))
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
free (a);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
remove_AT (die, attr_kind)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref *p;
|
||
dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (die != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
|
||
if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
|
||
{
|
||
removed = *p;
|
||
*p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (removed != 0)
|
||
free_AT (removed);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
free_die (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
remove_children (die);
|
||
free (die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Discard the children of this DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
remove_children (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
|
||
|
||
die->die_child = NULL;
|
||
|
||
while (child_die != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
|
||
child_die = child_die->die_sib;
|
||
|
||
for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
|
||
|
||
a = a->dw_attr_next;
|
||
free_AT (tmp_a);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
free_die (tmp_die);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
|
||
addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_child_die (die, child_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
dw_die_ref child_die;
|
||
{
|
||
if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (die == child_die)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
child_die->die_parent = die;
|
||
child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
|
||
die->die_child = child_die;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
|
||
is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
splice_child_die (parent, child)
|
||
dw_die_ref parent, child;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref *p;
|
||
|
||
/* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
|
||
specification DIE at toplevel. */
|
||
if (child->die_parent != parent)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
|
||
|
||
if (tmp)
|
||
child = tmp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (child->die_parent != parent
|
||
&& child->die_parent != get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
|
||
if (*p == child)
|
||
{
|
||
*p = child->die_sib;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
|
||
parent->die_child = child;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref
|
||
new_die (tag_value, parent_die, t)
|
||
enum dwarf_tag tag_value;
|
||
dw_die_ref parent_die;
|
||
tree t;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die = (dw_die_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (die_node));
|
||
|
||
die->die_tag = tag_value;
|
||
|
||
if (parent_die != NULL)
|
||
add_child_die (parent_die, die);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
|
||
|
||
limbo_node = (limbo_die_node *) xmalloc (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
|
||
limbo_node->die = die;
|
||
limbo_node->created_for = t;
|
||
limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
|
||
limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref
|
||
lookup_type_die (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die;
|
||
{
|
||
TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_die_ref
|
||
lookup_decl_die (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
|
||
|
||
return (decl_id < decl_die_table_in_use ? decl_die_table[decl_id] : NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref decl_die;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
|
||
unsigned int num_allocated;
|
||
|
||
if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
num_allocated
|
||
= ((decl_id + 1 + DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT - 1)
|
||
/ DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT)
|
||
* DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
|
||
decl_die_table
|
||
= (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (decl_die_table,
|
||
sizeof (dw_die_ref) * num_allocated);
|
||
|
||
memset ((char *) &decl_die_table[decl_die_table_allocated], 0,
|
||
(num_allocated - decl_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
|
||
decl_die_table_allocated = num_allocated;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_in_use)
|
||
decl_die_table_in_use = (decl_id + 1);
|
||
|
||
decl_die_table[decl_id] = decl_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
|
||
output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
|
||
the DIE internal representation. */
|
||
static int print_indent;
|
||
|
||
/* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
print_spaces (outfile)
|
||
FILE *outfile;
|
||
{
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
|
||
This routine is a debugging aid only. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
print_die (die, outfile)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
FILE *outfile;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
print_spaces (outfile);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
|
||
die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
|
||
print_spaces (outfile);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
|
||
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
{
|
||
print_spaces (outfile);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
|
||
|
||
switch (AT_class (a))
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "address");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "offset");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc_list:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
|
||
AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_range_list:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "range list");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%ld", AT_int (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%lu", AT_unsigned (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "floating-point constant");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
|
||
else
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_child != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
print_indent += 4;
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
print_die (c, outfile);
|
||
|
||
print_indent -= 4;
|
||
}
|
||
if (print_indent == 0)
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
|
||
This routine is a debugging aid only. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
print_dwarf_line_table (outfile)
|
||
FILE *outfile;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
dw_line_info_ref line_info;
|
||
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
|
||
for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
line_info = &line_info_table[i];
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%-20s", file_table.table[line_info->dw_file_num]);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
debug_dwarf_die (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
print_die (die, stderr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
|
||
This routine is a debugging aid only. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
debug_dwarf ()
|
||
{
|
||
print_indent = 0;
|
||
print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
|
||
if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
|
||
print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
|
||
onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
|
||
they are in order of addition. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
reverse_die_lists (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
|
||
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
|
||
{
|
||
an = a->dw_attr_next;
|
||
a->dw_attr_next = ap;
|
||
ap = a;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
die->die_attr = ap;
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
|
||
{
|
||
cn = c->die_sib;
|
||
c->die_sib = cp;
|
||
cp = c;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
die->die_child = cp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
|
||
reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
|
||
it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
|
||
reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
|
||
recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
reverse_all_dies (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
reverse_die_lists (die);
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
reverse_all_dies (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
|
||
for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
|
||
DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
push_new_compile_unit (old_unit, bincl_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref old_unit, bincl_die;
|
||
{
|
||
const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
|
||
dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
|
||
|
||
new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
|
||
return new_unit;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
pop_compile_unit (old_unit)
|
||
dw_die_ref old_unit;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
|
||
|
||
old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
|
||
return new_unit;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
|
||
#define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
loc_checksum (loc, ctx)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
struct md5_ctx *ctx;
|
||
{
|
||
CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
|
||
CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
|
||
CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
attr_checksum (at, ctx, mark)
|
||
dw_attr_ref at;
|
||
struct md5_ctx *ctx;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
rtx r;
|
||
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
|
||
|
||
/* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
|
||
if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
|
||
/* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
|
||
the output is the same, that's what matters. */
|
||
|| at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (AT_class (at))
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_float);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
r = AT_addr (at);
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (r))
|
||
{
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
|
||
loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
die_checksum (die, ctx, mark)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
struct md5_ctx *ctx;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
|
||
/* To avoid infinite recursion. */
|
||
if (die->die_mark)
|
||
{
|
||
CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
|
||
|
||
CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
|
||
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
die_checksum (c, ctx, mark);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#undef CHECKSUM
|
||
#undef CHECKSUM_STRING
|
||
|
||
/* Do the location expressions look same? */
|
||
static inline int
|
||
same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc1;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc2;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
|
||
&& same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
|
||
&& same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Do the values look the same? */
|
||
static int
|
||
same_dw_val_p (v1, v2, mark)
|
||
dw_val_node *v1;
|
||
dw_val_node *v2;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
|
||
rtx r1, r2;
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
|
||
if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
switch (v1->val_class)
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
|
||
&& v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
if (v1->v.val_float.length != v2->v.val_float.length)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < v1->v.val_float.length; i++)
|
||
if (v1->v.val_float.array[i] != v2->v.val_float.array[i])
|
||
return 0;
|
||
return 1;
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
return !strcmp((const char *) HT_STR (&v1->v.val_str->id),
|
||
(const char *) HT_STR (&v2->v.val_str->id));
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
|
||
r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (r1))
|
||
{
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
|
||
loc1 && loc2;
|
||
loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
|
||
if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
return !loc1 && !loc2;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Do the attributes look the same? */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
same_attr_p (at1, at2, mark)
|
||
dw_attr_ref at1;
|
||
dw_attr_ref at2;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
|
||
if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
|
||
/* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
|
||
the output is the same, that's what matters. */
|
||
|| at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Do the dies look the same? */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
same_die_p (die1, die2, mark)
|
||
dw_die_ref die1;
|
||
dw_die_ref die2;
|
||
int *mark;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c1, c2;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a1, a2;
|
||
|
||
/* To avoid infinite recursion. */
|
||
if (die1->die_mark)
|
||
return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
|
||
die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
|
||
|
||
if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
for (a1 = die1->die_attr, a2 = die2->die_attr;
|
||
a1 && a2;
|
||
a1 = a1->dw_attr_next, a2 = a2->dw_attr_next)
|
||
if (!same_attr_p (a1, a2, mark))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
if (a1 || a2)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
for (c1 = die1->die_child, c2 = die2->die_child;
|
||
c1 && c2;
|
||
c1 = c1->die_sib, c2 = c2->die_sib)
|
||
if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
if (c1 || c2)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
same_die_p_wrap (die1, die2)
|
||
dw_die_ref die1;
|
||
dw_die_ref die2;
|
||
{
|
||
int mark = 0;
|
||
int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
|
||
|
||
unmark_all_dies (die1);
|
||
unmark_all_dies (die2);
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
|
||
info section. */
|
||
static char *comdat_symbol_id;
|
||
|
||
/* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
|
||
static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
|
||
children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
compute_section_prefix (unit_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref unit_die;
|
||
{
|
||
const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
|
||
const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
|
||
char *name = (char *) alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
|
||
char *p;
|
||
int i, mark;
|
||
unsigned char checksum[16];
|
||
struct md5_ctx ctx;
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
|
||
the name filename of the unit. */
|
||
|
||
md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
|
||
mark = 0;
|
||
die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
|
||
unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
|
||
md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
|
||
|
||
sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
|
||
clean_symbol_name (name);
|
||
|
||
p = name + strlen (name);
|
||
for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
|
||
p += 2;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
|
||
comdat_symbol_number = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
is_type_die (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (die->die_tag)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_TAG_array_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_class_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_reference_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_string_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_structure_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_union_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_set_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_base_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_const_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_file_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_packed_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
|
||
case DW_TAG_typedef:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
default:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
|
||
Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
|
||
compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
|
||
compilations (functions). */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
is_comdat_die (c)
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
{
|
||
/* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
|
||
we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
|
||
objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
|
||
put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
|
||
|
||
if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
|
||
|| c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
|
||
|| c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
|
||
|| c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
|
||
|
||
return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return is_type_die (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
|
||
compilation unit. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
is_symbol_die (c)
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
{
|
||
return (is_type_die (c)
|
||
|| (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
|
||
&& !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static char *
|
||
gen_internal_sym (prefix)
|
||
const char *prefix;
|
||
{
|
||
char buf[256];
|
||
static int label_num;
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
|
||
return xstrdup (buf);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
assign_symbol_names (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
if (is_symbol_die (die))
|
||
{
|
||
if (comdat_symbol_id)
|
||
{
|
||
char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
|
||
|
||
sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
|
||
comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
|
||
die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
assign_symbol_names (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref cu;
|
||
unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
|
||
static hashval_t
|
||
htab_cu_hash (of)
|
||
const void *of;
|
||
{
|
||
const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
|
||
|
||
return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
htab_cu_eq (of1, of2)
|
||
const void *of1;
|
||
const void *of2;
|
||
{
|
||
const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
|
||
const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
|
||
|
||
return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
htab_cu_del (what)
|
||
void *what;
|
||
{
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
|
||
|
||
while (entry)
|
||
{
|
||
next = entry->next;
|
||
free (entry);
|
||
entry = next;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
|
||
accordingly. */
|
||
static int
|
||
check_duplicate_cu (cu, htable, sym_num)
|
||
dw_die_ref cu;
|
||
htab_t htable;
|
||
unsigned *sym_num;
|
||
{
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
|
||
|
||
dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
|
||
|
||
slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
|
||
htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
|
||
INSERT);
|
||
entry = *slot;
|
||
|
||
for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
|
||
{
|
||
if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (entry)
|
||
{
|
||
*sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
entry = xcalloc (1, sizeof (struct cu_hash_table_entry));
|
||
entry->cu = cu;
|
||
entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
|
||
entry->next = *slot;
|
||
*slot = entry;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
|
||
static void
|
||
record_comdat_symbol_number (cu, htable, sym_num)
|
||
dw_die_ref cu;
|
||
htab_t htable;
|
||
unsigned sym_num;
|
||
{
|
||
struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
|
||
|
||
slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
|
||
htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
|
||
NO_INSERT);
|
||
entry = *slot;
|
||
|
||
entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
|
||
additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
|
||
bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
break_out_includes (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref *ptr;
|
||
dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
|
||
limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
|
||
htab_t cu_hash_table;
|
||
|
||
for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
|
||
|
||
if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
|
||
|| (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
|
||
*ptr = c->die_sib;
|
||
|
||
if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
|
||
{
|
||
unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
|
||
free_die (c);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
|
||
{
|
||
unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
|
||
free_die (c);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
add_child_die (unit, c);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
|
||
ptr = &(c->die_sib);
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
|
||
to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
|
||
if (unit != NULL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
assign_symbol_names (die);
|
||
cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
|
||
for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
|
||
node;
|
||
node = node->next)
|
||
{
|
||
int is_dupl;
|
||
|
||
compute_section_prefix (node->die);
|
||
is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
|
||
&comdat_symbol_number);
|
||
assign_symbol_names (node->die);
|
||
if (is_dupl)
|
||
*pnode = node->next;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
pnode = &node->next;
|
||
record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
|
||
comdat_symbol_number);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
|
||
effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
|
||
avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_sibling_attributes (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
|
||
&& die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
|
||
/* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
add_sibling_attributes (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_location_lists (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
dw_attr_ref d_attr;
|
||
|
||
for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
|
||
if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
|
||
output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
output_location_lists (c);
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
|
||
abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
|
||
a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
|
||
die are visited recursively. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
build_abbrev_table (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long abbrev_id;
|
||
unsigned int n_alloc;
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
|
||
|
||
/* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
|
||
DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
|
||
for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
|
||
if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
|
||
&& AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
|
||
|
||
if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
|
||
{
|
||
a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
|
||
d_attr = die->die_attr;
|
||
|
||
while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
|
||
|| (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
|
||
d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
|
||
{
|
||
if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
abbrev_die_table
|
||
= (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (abbrev_die_table,
|
||
sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
|
||
|
||
memset ((char *) &abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
|
||
(n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
|
||
abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
|
||
abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
build_abbrev_table (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
constant_size (value)
|
||
long unsigned value;
|
||
{
|
||
int log;
|
||
|
||
if (value == 0)
|
||
log = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
log = floor_log2 (value);
|
||
|
||
log = log / 8;
|
||
log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
|
||
|
||
return log;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
|
||
.debug_info section. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned long
|
||
size_of_die (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size = 0;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
|
||
size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (AT_class (a))
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
|
||
|
||
/* Block length. */
|
||
size += constant_size (lsize);
|
||
size += lsize;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc_list:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_range_list:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
size += 1 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4; /* block */
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
size += 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
else
|
||
size += HT_LEN (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id) + 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return size;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
|
||
DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
|
||
each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
|
||
die_offset field in each DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
calc_die_sizes (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
|
||
next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
calc_die_sizes (c);
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_child != NULL)
|
||
/* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
|
||
next_die_offset += 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
|
||
that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
|
||
DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
|
||
and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
mark_dies (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_mark)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
die->die_mark = 1;
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
mark_dies (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
unmark_dies (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
|
||
if (!die->die_mark)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
die->die_mark = 0;
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
unmark_dies (c);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
unmark_all_dies (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
|
||
if (!die->die_mark)
|
||
return;
|
||
die->die_mark = 0;
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
unmark_all_dies (c);
|
||
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
|
||
unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
|
||
compilation unit. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned long
|
||
size_of_pubnames ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
|
||
size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
|
||
for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
|
||
return size;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned long
|
||
size_of_aranges ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
|
||
size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
|
||
|
||
/* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
|
||
size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
/* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
|
||
size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
return size;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
|
||
|
||
static enum dwarf_form
|
||
value_format (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
return DW_FORM_addr;
|
||
case dw_val_class_range_list:
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
|
||
return DW_FORM_data4;
|
||
if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
|
||
return DW_FORM_data8;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc_list:
|
||
/* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
|
||
.debug_loc section */
|
||
return DW_FORM_data4;
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
|
||
{
|
||
case 1:
|
||
return DW_FORM_block1;
|
||
case 2:
|
||
return DW_FORM_block2;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
return DW_FORM_sdata;
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
|
||
{
|
||
case 1:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data1;
|
||
case 2:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data2;
|
||
case 4:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data4;
|
||
case 8:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data8;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
return DW_FORM_block1;
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
return DW_FORM_block1;
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
return DW_FORM_flag;
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
if (AT_ref_external (a))
|
||
return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
|
||
else
|
||
return DW_FORM_ref;
|
||
case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data;
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
return DW_FORM_addr;
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
return DW_FORM_data;
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
return AT_string_form (a);
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_value_format (a)
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
|
||
table. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_abbrev_section ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long abbrev_id;
|
||
|
||
dw_attr_ref a_attr;
|
||
|
||
for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
|
||
dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
|
||
|
||
if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
|
||
|
||
for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
|
||
a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
|
||
dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
|
||
output_value_format (a_attr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Terminate the table. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
output_die_symbol (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
char *sym = die->die_symbol;
|
||
|
||
if (sym == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
|
||
/* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
|
||
.linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
|
||
will break. */
|
||
(*targetm.asm_out.globalize_label) (asm_out_file, sym);
|
||
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
|
||
expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
|
||
this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
|
||
|
||
static inline dw_loc_list_ref
|
||
new_loc_list (expr, begin, end, section, gensym)
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
|
||
const char *begin;
|
||
const char *end;
|
||
const char *section;
|
||
unsigned gensym;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref retlist
|
||
= (dw_loc_list_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
|
||
|
||
retlist->begin = begin;
|
||
retlist->end = end;
|
||
retlist->expr = expr;
|
||
retlist->section = section;
|
||
if (gensym)
|
||
retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
|
||
|
||
return retlist;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a location description expression to a location list */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (list_head, descr, begin, end, section)
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref *list_head;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
|
||
const char *begin;
|
||
const char *end;
|
||
const char *section;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref *d;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the end of the chain. */
|
||
for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
/* Add a new location list node to the list */
|
||
*d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the location list given to us */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_loc_list (list_head)
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref list_head;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
|
||
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? This shouldn't be needed now that we've forced the
|
||
compilation unit base address to zero when there is code
|
||
in more than one section. */
|
||
if (strcmp (curr->section, ".text") == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* dw2_asm_output_data will mask off any extra bits in the ~0. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
|
||
"Location list base address specifier fake entry");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->section,
|
||
"Location list base address specifier base");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
|
||
"Location list begin address (%s)",
|
||
list_head->ll_symbol);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
|
||
"Location list end address (%s)",
|
||
list_head->ll_symbol);
|
||
size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
|
||
|
||
/* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
|
||
if (size > 0xffff)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
|
||
|
||
output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
|
||
"Location list terminator begin (%s)",
|
||
list_head->ll_symbol);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
|
||
"Location list terminator end (%s)",
|
||
list_head->ll_symbol);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
|
||
the definitions of each child DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_die (die)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_attr_ref a;
|
||
dw_die_ref c;
|
||
unsigned long size;
|
||
|
||
/* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
|
||
them to point to. */
|
||
if (die->die_symbol)
|
||
output_die_symbol (die);
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
|
||
die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
|
||
|
||
for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
|
||
|
||
switch (AT_class (a))
|
||
{
|
||
case dw_val_class_addr:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_offset:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
|
||
"%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_range_list:
|
||
{
|
||
char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
|
||
|
||
sprintf (p, "+0x%lx", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
|
||
"%s", name);
|
||
*p = '\0';
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc:
|
||
size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
|
||
|
||
/* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
|
||
|
||
output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_const:
|
||
/* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
|
||
used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
|
||
extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
|
||
AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_long_long:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1,
|
||
2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
|
||
"%s", name);
|
||
|
||
if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
{
|
||
first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
|
||
second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
|
||
second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
|
||
first, "long long constant");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
|
||
second, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_float:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int i;
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4,
|
||
"%s", name);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length; i++)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (4, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array[i],
|
||
"fp constant word %u", i);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_flag:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_loc_list:
|
||
{
|
||
char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
|
||
|
||
if (sym == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym,
|
||
loc_section_label, "%s", name);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_die_ref:
|
||
if (AT_ref_external (a))
|
||
{
|
||
char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
|
||
|
||
if (sym == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (AT_ref (a)->die_offset == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
|
||
"%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
|
||
{
|
||
char l1[20];
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case dw_val_class_str:
|
||
if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
|
||
a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
|
||
"%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
|
||
output_die (c);
|
||
|
||
/* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
|
||
if (die->die_child != NULL)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
|
||
die->die_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
|
||
.debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_compilation_unit_header ()
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
|
||
"Length of Compilation Unit Info");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
|
||
"Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_comp_unit (die, output_if_empty)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
int output_if_empty;
|
||
{
|
||
const char *secname;
|
||
char *oldsym, *tmp;
|
||
|
||
/* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
|
||
if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
|
||
about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
|
||
will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
|
||
will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
|
||
this CU so we know which get local refs. */
|
||
mark_dies (die);
|
||
|
||
build_abbrev_table (die);
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
|
||
next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
|
||
calc_die_sizes (die);
|
||
|
||
oldsym = die->die_symbol;
|
||
if (oldsym)
|
||
{
|
||
tmp = (char *) alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
|
||
|
||
sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
|
||
secname = tmp;
|
||
die->die_symbol = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
secname = (const char *) DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
|
||
|
||
/* Output debugging information. */
|
||
named_section_flags (secname, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
output_compilation_unit_header ();
|
||
output_die (die);
|
||
|
||
/* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
|
||
output_pubnames. */
|
||
if (oldsym)
|
||
{
|
||
unmark_dies (die);
|
||
die->die_symbol = oldsym;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
|
||
output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
|
||
"A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
dwarf2_name (decl, scope)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
int scope;
|
||
{
|
||
return (*lang_hooks.decl_printable_name) (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_pubname (decl, die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
pubname_ref p;
|
||
|
||
if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
pubname_table
|
||
= (pubname_ref) xrealloc (pubname_table,
|
||
(pubname_table_allocated
|
||
* sizeof (pubname_entry)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
|
||
p->die = die;
|
||
p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
|
||
visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
|
||
visible procedures. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_pubnames ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
|
||
"Length of Public Names Info");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
|
||
"Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
|
||
"Compilation Unit Length");
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
|
||
|
||
/* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
|
||
if (pub->die->die_mark == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
|
||
"DIE offset");
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_arange (decl, die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
{
|
||
if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
arange_table = (dw_die_ref *)
|
||
xrealloc (arange_table, arange_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
|
||
Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
|
||
text section generated for this compilation unit. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_aranges ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
|
||
"Length of Address Ranges Info");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
|
||
"Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
|
||
|
||
/* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
|
||
if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
|
||
pointer size. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
|
||
2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
|
||
for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
|
||
text_section_label, "Length");
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
|
||
|
||
/* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
|
||
if (die->die_mark == 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
|
||
"Address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
|
||
get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
|
||
Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
|
||
aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
|
||
dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
|
||
if (! a || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
loc = AT_loc (a);
|
||
if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_addr)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
|
||
loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
|
||
get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
|
||
"Length");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the terminator words. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
|
||
was placed. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned int
|
||
add_ranges (block)
|
||
tree block;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
|
||
|
||
if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
ranges_table = (dw_ranges_ref)
|
||
xrealloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
|
||
* sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
|
||
ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
|
||
|
||
return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_ranges ()
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
|
||
const char *fmt = start_fmt;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
|
||
|
||
if (block_num)
|
||
{
|
||
char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
|
||
|
||
/* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
|
||
unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
|
||
base of the text section. */
|
||
if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
|
||
text_section_label,
|
||
fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
|
||
text_section_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
|
||
compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
|
||
use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
|
||
target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
|
||
fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
fmt = NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
|
||
fmt = start_fmt;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Data structure containing information about input files. */
|
||
struct file_info
|
||
{
|
||
char *path; /* Complete file name. */
|
||
char *fname; /* File name part. */
|
||
int length; /* Length of entire string. */
|
||
int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
|
||
int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Data structure containing information about directories with source
|
||
files. */
|
||
struct dir_info
|
||
{
|
||
char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
|
||
int length; /* Path length. */
|
||
int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
|
||
int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
|
||
int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
|
||
int used; /* Used in the end? */
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
|
||
the directories in the path. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
file_info_cmp (p1, p2)
|
||
const void *p1;
|
||
const void *p2;
|
||
{
|
||
const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
|
||
const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
|
||
unsigned char *cp1;
|
||
unsigned char *cp2;
|
||
|
||
/* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
|
||
we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
|
||
we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
|
||
orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
|
||
1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
|
||
if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
|
||
return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
|
||
|
||
cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
|
||
cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
|
||
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
++cp1;
|
||
++cp2;
|
||
/* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
|
||
if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
|
||
|| (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
|
||
return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
|
||
- (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
|
||
|
||
/* Character of current path component the same? */
|
||
else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
|
||
return *cp1 - *cp2;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
|
||
the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
|
||
slowdowns with many input files. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_file_names ()
|
||
{
|
||
struct file_info *files;
|
||
struct dir_info *dirs;
|
||
int *saved;
|
||
int *savehere;
|
||
int *backmap;
|
||
int ndirs;
|
||
int idx_offset;
|
||
int i;
|
||
int idx;
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
|
||
files = (struct file_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
|
||
* sizeof (struct file_info));
|
||
dirs = (struct dir_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
|
||
* sizeof (struct dir_info));
|
||
|
||
/* Sort the file names. */
|
||
for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
char *f;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip all leading "./". */
|
||
f = file_table.table[i];
|
||
while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
|
||
f += 2;
|
||
|
||
/* Create a new array entry. */
|
||
files[i].path = f;
|
||
files[i].length = strlen (f);
|
||
files[i].file_idx = i;
|
||
|
||
/* Search for the file name part. */
|
||
f = strrchr (f, '/');
|
||
files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
qsort (files + 1, file_table.in_use - 1, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
|
||
|
||
/* Find all the different directories used. */
|
||
dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
|
||
dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
|
||
dirs[0].prefix = -1;
|
||
dirs[0].count = 1;
|
||
dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
|
||
dirs[0].used = 0;
|
||
files[1].dir_idx = 0;
|
||
ndirs = 1;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 2; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
|
||
if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
|
||
&& memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
|
||
dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Same directory as last entry. */
|
||
files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
|
||
++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
int j;
|
||
|
||
/* This is a new directory. */
|
||
dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
|
||
dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
|
||
dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
|
||
dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
|
||
dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
|
||
files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
|
||
|
||
/* Search for a prefix. */
|
||
dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
|
||
for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
|
||
if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
|
||
&& dirs[j].length > 1
|
||
&& (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
|
||
|| dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
|
||
&& memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
|
||
dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
|
||
|
||
++ndirs;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
|
||
allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
|
||
with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
|
||
where we would have to check out every combination of every single
|
||
possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
|
||
results in most cases and never is much off. */
|
||
saved = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
|
||
savehere = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
|
||
|
||
memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
|
||
for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
int j;
|
||
int total;
|
||
|
||
/* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
|
||
does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
|
||
savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
|
||
total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
|
||
|
||
for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
|
||
{
|
||
savehere[j] = 0;
|
||
if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
|
||
dirs[j] path. */
|
||
int k;
|
||
|
||
k = dirs[j].prefix;
|
||
while (k != -1 && k != i)
|
||
k = dirs[k].prefix;
|
||
|
||
if (k == i)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
|
||
writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
|
||
dirs[i]. */
|
||
savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
|
||
total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
|
||
directory. */
|
||
if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* It's worthwhile adding. */
|
||
for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
|
||
if (savehere[j] > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
|
||
saved[j] = savehere[j];
|
||
|
||
/* Remember the prefix directory. */
|
||
dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
|
||
since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
|
||
efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
|
||
backmap = (int *) alloca (file_table.in_use * sizeof (int));
|
||
for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
|
||
|
||
/* Mark this directory as used. */
|
||
dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
|
||
directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
|
||
directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
|
||
directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
|
||
constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
|
||
idx = 1;
|
||
idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
|
||
for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
|
||
if (dirs[i].used != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
dirs[i].used = idx++;
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
|
||
"Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
|
||
|
||
/* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
|
||
exists. */
|
||
if (idx_offset == 0)
|
||
dirs[0].used = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Now write all the file names. */
|
||
for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
int file_idx = backmap[i];
|
||
int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
|
||
"File Entry: 0x%x", i);
|
||
|
||
/* Include directory index. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* Modification time. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
|
||
|
||
/* File length in bytes. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
|
||
information goes into the .debug_line section. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
output_line_info ()
|
||
{
|
||
char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
|
||
char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
unsigned opc;
|
||
unsigned n_op_args;
|
||
unsigned long lt_index;
|
||
unsigned long current_line;
|
||
long line_offset;
|
||
long line_delta;
|
||
unsigned long current_file;
|
||
unsigned long function;
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
|
||
"Length of Source Line Info");
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
|
||
|
||
/* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
|
||
bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
|
||
information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
|
||
we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
|
||
generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
|
||
DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
|
||
commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
|
||
enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
|
||
"Minimum Instruction Length");
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
|
||
"Default is_stmt_start flag");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
|
||
"Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
|
||
"Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
|
||
"Special Opcode Base");
|
||
|
||
for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (opc)
|
||
{
|
||
case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
|
||
case DW_LNS_advance_line:
|
||
case DW_LNS_set_file:
|
||
case DW_LNS_set_column:
|
||
case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
|
||
n_op_args = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
n_op_args = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
|
||
opc, n_op_args);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Write out the information about the files we use. */
|
||
output_file_names ();
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
|
||
|
||
/* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
|
||
section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
|
||
have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
|
||
a series of state machine operations. */
|
||
current_file = 1;
|
||
current_line = 1;
|
||
strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
|
||
for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
|
||
at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
|
||
prologue. */
|
||
|
||
/* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
|
||
address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
|
||
that anything after the last address is this line. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
|
||
&& line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
|
||
continue;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
|
||
|
||
Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
|
||
use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
|
||
itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
|
||
attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
|
||
could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
|
||
use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
|
||
if (0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
|
||
"DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This can handle any delta. This takes
|
||
4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
|
||
different from the previous line. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
|
||
{
|
||
current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
|
||
file_table.table[current_file]);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
|
||
that uses the least amount of space. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
|
||
{
|
||
line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
|
||
line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
|
||
current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
|
||
if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
|
||
/* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
|
||
definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
|
||
takes 1 byte. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
|
||
"line %lu", current_line);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
|
||
depending on the value being encoded. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
|
||
"advance to line %lu", current_line);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
/* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
|
||
if (0)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
|
||
"DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
|
||
|
||
function = 0;
|
||
current_file = 1;
|
||
current_line = 1;
|
||
for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
|
||
= &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
|
||
&& line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
|
||
&& line_info->function == function)
|
||
goto cont;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
|
||
a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
|
||
to handle it differently. */
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
|
||
lt_index);
|
||
if (function != line_info->function)
|
||
{
|
||
function = line_info->function;
|
||
|
||
/* Set the address register to the first line in the function */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
|
||
if (0)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
|
||
"DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
|
||
different from the previous line. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
|
||
{
|
||
current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
|
||
file_table.table[current_file]);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
|
||
that uses the least amount of space. */
|
||
if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
|
||
{
|
||
line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
|
||
line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
|
||
current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
|
||
if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
|
||
"line %lu", current_line);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
|
||
"advance to line %lu", current_line);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
cont:
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
lt_index++;
|
||
|
||
/* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
|
||
if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
|
||
|| separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
|
||
{
|
||
current_file = 1;
|
||
current_line = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
|
||
if (0)
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
|
||
"DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
|
||
a DIE that describes the given type.
|
||
|
||
This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
|
||
Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
base_type_die (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref base_type_result;
|
||
const char *type_name;
|
||
enum dwarf_type encoding;
|
||
tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (name)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
|
||
name = DECL_NAME (name);
|
||
|
||
type_name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
type_name = "__unknown__";
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case INTEGER_TYPE:
|
||
/* Carefully distinguish the C character types, without messing
|
||
up if the language is not C. Note that we check only for the names
|
||
that contain spaces; other names might occur by coincidence in other
|
||
languages. */
|
||
if (! (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
|
||
&& (type == char_type_node
|
||
|| ! strcmp (type_name, "signed char")
|
||
|| ! strcmp (type_name, "unsigned char"))))
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
|
||
else
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
/* else fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case CHAR_TYPE:
|
||
/* GNU Pascal/Ada CHAR type. Not used in C. */
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
|
||
else
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case REAL_TYPE:
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_float;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
|
||
a user defined type for it. */
|
||
case COMPLEX_TYPE:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
|
||
else
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
|
||
/* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
|
||
encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
/* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
|
||
if (demangle_name_func)
|
||
type_name = (*demangle_name_func) (type_name);
|
||
|
||
add_AT_string (base_type_result, DW_AT_name, type_name);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
|
||
int_size_in_bytes (type));
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
|
||
|
||
return base_type_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
|
||
the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
|
||
a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
|
||
given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
|
||
type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
|
||
type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
|
||
type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
|
||
root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
root_type (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return error_mark_node;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
return error_mark_node;
|
||
|
||
case POINTER_TYPE:
|
||
case REFERENCE_TYPE:
|
||
return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return type_main_variant (type);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
|
||
given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_base_type (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
case VOID_TYPE:
|
||
case INTEGER_TYPE:
|
||
case REAL_TYPE:
|
||
case COMPLEX_TYPE:
|
||
case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
|
||
case CHAR_TYPE:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
case SET_TYPE:
|
||
case ARRAY_TYPE:
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
|
||
case FUNCTION_TYPE:
|
||
case METHOD_TYPE:
|
||
case POINTER_TYPE:
|
||
case REFERENCE_TYPE:
|
||
case FILE_TYPE:
|
||
case OFFSET_TYPE:
|
||
case LANG_TYPE:
|
||
case VECTOR_TYPE:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
|
||
entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
modified_type_die (type, is_const_type, is_volatile_type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
int is_const_type;
|
||
int is_volatile_type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
|
||
dw_die_ref mod_type_die = NULL;
|
||
dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
|
||
tree item_type = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (code != ERROR_MARK)
|
||
{
|
||
tree qualified_type;
|
||
|
||
/* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
|
||
this type. */
|
||
qualified_type
|
||
= get_qualified_type (type,
|
||
((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
|
||
| (is_volatile_type
|
||
? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
|
||
|
||
/* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
|
||
if (qualified_type)
|
||
{
|
||
mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
|
||
if (mod_type_die)
|
||
return mod_type_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle C typedef types. */
|
||
if (qualified_type && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL
|
||
&& DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
|
||
{
|
||
tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (qualified_type);
|
||
tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (type_name);
|
||
|
||
if (qualified_type == dtype)
|
||
{
|
||
/* For a named type, use the typedef. */
|
||
gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
|
||
mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
|
||
|| is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype))
|
||
/* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
|
||
type to which it refers. */
|
||
mod_type_die
|
||
= modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (type_name),
|
||
is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
|
||
context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (mod_type_die)
|
||
/* OK. */
|
||
;
|
||
else if (is_const_type)
|
||
{
|
||
mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
|
||
sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (is_volatile_type)
|
||
{
|
||
mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
|
||
sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
|
||
#if 0
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
|
||
#if 0
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (is_base_type (type))
|
||
mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gen_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
|
||
`lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
|
||
might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
|
||
copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
|
||
that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
|
||
..._TYPE node. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
|
||
mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
|
||
else
|
||
/* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
|
||
not the main variant. */
|
||
mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
|
||
if (mod_type_die == NULL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We want to equate the qualified type to the die below. */
|
||
type = qualified_type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (type)
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, mod_type_die);
|
||
if (item_type)
|
||
/* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
|
||
this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
|
||
recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
|
||
types are possible in Ada. */
|
||
sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
|
||
TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
|
||
TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
|
||
context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (sub_die != NULL)
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
|
||
|
||
return mod_type_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
|
||
an enumerated type. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
type_is_enum (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the register number described by a given RTL node. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned int
|
||
reg_number (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
|
||
|
||
if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
|
||
zero if there is no such. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
reg_loc_descriptor (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
|
||
unsigned reg;
|
||
|
||
if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
reg = reg_number (rtl);
|
||
if (reg <= 31)
|
||
loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + reg, 0, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, reg, 0);
|
||
|
||
return loc_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
int_loc_descriptor (i)
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT i;
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom op;
|
||
|
||
/* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
|
||
defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
|
||
if (i >= 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (i <= 31)
|
||
op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
|
||
else if (i <= 0xff)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const1u;
|
||
else if (i <= 0xffff)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const2u;
|
||
else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
|
||
|| i <= 0xffffffff)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const4u;
|
||
else
|
||
op = DW_OP_constu;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (i >= -0x80)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const1s;
|
||
else if (i >= -0x8000)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const2s;
|
||
else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
|
||
|| i >= -0x80000000)
|
||
op = DW_OP_const4s;
|
||
else
|
||
op = DW_OP_consts;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
based_loc_descr (reg, offset)
|
||
unsigned reg;
|
||
long int offset;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
|
||
/* For the "frame base", we use the frame pointer or stack pointer
|
||
registers, since the RTL for local variables is relative to one of
|
||
them. */
|
||
unsigned fp_reg = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (frame_pointer_needed
|
||
? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
: STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
|
||
|
||
if (reg == fp_reg)
|
||
loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
|
||
else if (reg <= 31)
|
||
loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + reg, offset, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
|
||
|
||
return loc_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_based_loc (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
|
||
&& ((GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == REG
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
|
||
(resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
|
||
mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
|
||
hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
|
||
|
||
When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
|
||
the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
|
||
equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
|
||
it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
|
||
|
||
MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
|
||
autoincrement addressing modes.
|
||
|
||
Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
|
||
description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
|
||
actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
|
||
zeroth element of the array. */
|
||
|
||
#ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
|
||
rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
case POST_DEC:
|
||
case POST_MODIFY:
|
||
/* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
|
||
just fall into the SUBREG code. */
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case SUBREG:
|
||
/* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
|
||
variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
|
||
up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
|
||
legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
|
||
contains the given subreg. */
|
||
rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case REG:
|
||
/* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
|
||
method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
|
||
object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
|
||
a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
|
||
what category of register the hardware believes the given register
|
||
belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
|
||
here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
|
||
data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
|
||
OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
|
||
may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
|
||
the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
|
||
memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
|
||
distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
|
||
if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (rtl), 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
|
||
if (mem_loc_result != 0)
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LO_SUM:
|
||
rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
/* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
|
||
the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
|
||
pool. */
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
/* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
|
||
by a different symbol. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
bool marked;
|
||
rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
rtl = tmp;
|
||
if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
|
||
get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
|
||
else
|
||
marked = true;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
|
||
it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
|
||
FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
|
||
DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
|
||
if (!marked)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
|
||
mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
|
||
mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
|
||
VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PRE_MODIFY:
|
||
/* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
|
||
PLUS code below. */
|
||
rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
|
||
goto plus;
|
||
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
/* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
|
||
below. */
|
||
rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
|
||
GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
|
||
? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
|
||
: -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
plus:
|
||
if (is_based_loc (rtl))
|
||
mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
|
||
INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
|
||
if (mem_loc_result == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
|
||
INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
|
||
mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
{
|
||
/* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
|
||
be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply. */
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
|
||
|
||
if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
mem_loc_result = op0;
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ADDRESSOF:
|
||
/* If this is a MEM, return its address. Otherwise, we can't
|
||
represent this. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == MEM)
|
||
return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0), mode);
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return mem_loc_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
|
||
This is typically a complex variable. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
concat_loc_descriptor (x0, x1)
|
||
rtx x0, x1;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
|
||
|
||
if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
|
||
add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)), 0));
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)), 0));
|
||
|
||
return cc_loc_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
|
||
which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
|
||
register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
|
||
memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
|
||
generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
|
||
|
||
If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
loc_descriptor (rtl)
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case SUBREG:
|
||
/* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
|
||
variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
|
||
up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
|
||
legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
|
||
contains the given subreg. */
|
||
rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case REG:
|
||
loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONCAT:
|
||
loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return loc_result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
|
||
up particularly with variable length arrays. If ADDRESSP is nonzero, we are
|
||
looking for an address. Otherwise, we return a value. If we can't make a
|
||
descriptor, return 0. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_loc_descr_ref
|
||
loc_descriptor_from_tree (loc, addressp)
|
||
tree loc;
|
||
int addressp;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
|
||
int indirect_p = 0;
|
||
int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom op;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
|
||
extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
|
||
problem... */
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
|
||
case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
|
||
/* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
|
||
position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
|
||
only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
|
||
the names of types. */
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case CALL_EXPR:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case ADDR_EXPR:
|
||
/* We can support this only if we can look through conversions and
|
||
find an INDIRECT_EXPR. */
|
||
for (loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0);
|
||
TREE_CODE (loc) == CONVERT_EXPR || TREE_CODE (loc) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (loc) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (loc) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (loc) == SAVE_EXPR;
|
||
loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
return (TREE_CODE (loc) == INDIRECT_REF
|
||
? loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp)
|
||
: 0);
|
||
|
||
case VAR_DECL:
|
||
if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL (loc))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
|
||
#ifndef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
|
||
/* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
|
||
return 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
|
||
look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
|
||
if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
|
||
if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (rtl) != MEM)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
|
||
ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
|
||
ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
|
||
|
||
ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
|
||
|
||
indirect_p = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
/* FALLTHRU */
|
||
|
||
case PARM_DECL:
|
||
{
|
||
rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
|
||
|
||
if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
|
||
ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
|
||
ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
|
||
indirect_p = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
indirect_p = 1;
|
||
rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
|
||
indirect_p = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case COMPOUND_EXPR:
|
||
return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), addressp);
|
||
|
||
case NOP_EXPR:
|
||
case CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
case SAVE_EXPR:
|
||
return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp);
|
||
|
||
case COMPONENT_REF:
|
||
case BIT_FIELD_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
tree obj, offset;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
int volatilep;
|
||
|
||
obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
|
||
&unsignedp, &volatilep);
|
||
|
||
if (obj == loc)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (obj, 1);
|
||
if (ret == 0
|
||
|| bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (offset != NULL_TREE)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Variable offset. */
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree (offset, 0));
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!addressp)
|
||
indirect_p = 1;
|
||
|
||
bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
if (bytepos > 0)
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
|
||
else if (bytepos < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case INTEGER_CST:
|
||
if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
|
||
ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
|
||
case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
|
||
case BIT_AND_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_and;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
|
||
case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_xor;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
|
||
case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
|
||
case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_or;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_div;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case MINUS_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_minus;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_mod;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case MULT_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_mul;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case LSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_shl;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case RSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
op = (unsignedp ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
|
||
{
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
|
||
if (ret == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
|
||
tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
|
||
0),
|
||
0));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op = DW_OP_plus;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case LE_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
op = DW_OP_le;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case GE_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
op = DW_OP_ge;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case LT_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
op = DW_OP_lt;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case GT_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
op = DW_OP_gt;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case EQ_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_eq;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
case NE_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_ne;
|
||
goto do_binop;
|
||
|
||
do_binop:
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
|
||
ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
|
||
if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
|
||
case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_not;
|
||
goto do_unop;
|
||
|
||
case ABS_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_abs;
|
||
goto do_unop;
|
||
|
||
case NEGATE_EXPR:
|
||
op = DW_OP_neg;
|
||
goto do_unop;
|
||
|
||
do_unop:
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
|
||
if (ret == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MAX_EXPR:
|
||
loc = build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
|
||
build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case COND_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
|
||
= loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
|
||
= loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
|
||
|
||
ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
|
||
if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
|
||
jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
|
||
bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
|
||
bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
|
||
jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
|
||
jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
|
||
if (addressp && indirect_p == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
|
||
if (!addressp && indirect_p > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
|
||
|
||
if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
|
||
op = DW_OP_deref;
|
||
else
|
||
op = DW_OP_deref_size;
|
||
|
||
add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
|
||
which is not less than the value itself. */
|
||
|
||
static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
ceiling (value, boundary)
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT value;
|
||
unsigned int boundary;
|
||
{
|
||
return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
|
||
pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
|
||
`integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
|
||
ERROR_MARK node. */
|
||
|
||
static inline tree
|
||
field_type (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
tree type;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return integer_type_node;
|
||
|
||
type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
|
||
if (type == NULL_TREE)
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
||
|
||
return type;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
|
||
it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
|
||
be an ERROR_MARK node. */
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned
|
||
simple_type_align_in_bits (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned
|
||
simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
|
||
node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
|
||
return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
|
||
else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
|
||
ERROR_MARK node. */
|
||
|
||
static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
simple_type_size_in_bits (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return BITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
|
||
return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
|
||
else
|
||
return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
|
||
lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
|
||
or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
|
||
because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
|
||
because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
|
||
just yet). */
|
||
|
||
static HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
field_byte_offset (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
|
||
unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
|
||
tree type;
|
||
tree field_size_tree;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
type = field_type (decl);
|
||
field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
|
||
a flexible array member. */
|
||
if (! field_size_tree)
|
||
field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
|
||
|
||
/* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
|
||
for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
|
||
be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
|
||
if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
|
||
if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
|
||
field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
|
||
type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
|
||
type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
|
||
decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
|
||
bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
|
||
hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
|
||
the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
|
||
bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
|
||
tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
|
||
type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
|
||
long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
|
||
|
||
struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
|
||
|
||
Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
|
||
cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
|
||
structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
|
||
for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
|
||
bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
|
||
boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
|
||
of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
|
||
there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
|
||
(when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
|
||
bits of the bit-field itself.
|
||
|
||
This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
|
||
object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
|
||
allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
|
||
to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
|
||
boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
|
||
bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
|
||
bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
|
||
example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
|
||
object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
|
||
|
||
Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
|
||
given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
|
||
that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
|
||
we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
|
||
DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
|
||
and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
|
||
"deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
|
||
deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
|
||
|
||
/* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
|
||
lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
|
||
object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
|
||
|
||
/* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
|
||
object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
|
||
object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
|
||
object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
|
||
|
||
if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
|
||
object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
|
||
|
||
/* Round up to decl_align instead. */
|
||
object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
|
||
object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
|
||
object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
|
||
associated with them. */
|
||
|
||
/* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
|
||
|
||
This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
|
||
whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
|
||
generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_AT_location_description (die, attr_kind, descr)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
|
||
{
|
||
if (descr != 0)
|
||
add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
|
||
struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
|
||
represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
|
||
descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
|
||
byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
|
||
the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
|
||
function above).
|
||
|
||
For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
|
||
(of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
|
||
type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
|
||
declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
|
||
DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
|
||
bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
|
||
DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
|
||
`byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
|
||
value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
|
||
function below.) */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_data_member_location_attribute (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
long offset;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_VEC)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
|
||
if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (decl) && is_cxx ())
|
||
{
|
||
/* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
|
||
aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
|
||
type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
|
||
vtable. The following dwarf expression means
|
||
|
||
BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
|
||
|
||
This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
|
||
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
|
||
|
||
/* Make a copy of the object address. */
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
|
||
/* Extract the vtable address. */
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
|
||
/* Calculate the address of the offset. */
|
||
offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
|
||
if (offset >= 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
|
||
/* Extract the offset. */
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
|
||
/* Add it to the object address. */
|
||
tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
|
||
add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
|
||
|
||
if (! loc_descr)
|
||
{
|
||
enum dwarf_location_atom op;
|
||
|
||
/* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
|
||
address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
|
||
address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
|
||
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
|
||
operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
|
||
stack. */
|
||
op = DW_OP_constu;
|
||
#else
|
||
op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attach an DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
|
||
does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
|
||
things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
|
||
to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
|
||
constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
/* Note that a CONST_INT rtx could represent either an integer
|
||
or a floating-point constant. A CONST_INT is used whenever
|
||
the constant will fit into a single word. In all such
|
||
cases, the original mode of the constant value is wiped
|
||
out, and the CONST_INT rtx is assigned VOIDmode. */
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
|
||
if (val < 0 && (long) val == val)
|
||
add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, (long) val);
|
||
else if ((unsigned long) val == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val)
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned long) val);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
#if HOST_BITS_PER_LONG * 2 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
val >> HOST_BITS_PER_LONG, val);
|
||
#else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
/* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
|
||
floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
|
||
constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
|
||
represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4;
|
||
long *array = (long *) xmalloc (sizeof (long) * length);
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
|
||
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
|
||
switch (mode)
|
||
{
|
||
case SFmode:
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, array[0]);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case DFmode:
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (rv, array);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case XFmode:
|
||
case TFmode:
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (rv, array);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_AT_float (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, array);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
|
||
if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG != HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_STRING:
|
||
add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
|
||
VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
/* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
|
||
the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
|
||
can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
|
||
variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
|
||
corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
|
||
like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
|
||
exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
|
||
of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
|
||
*value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
|
||
lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
|
||
values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
/* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
rtl_for_decl_location (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
|
||
/* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
|
||
(as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
|
||
choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
|
||
|
||
DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
|
||
activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
|
||
could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
|
||
that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
|
||
generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
|
||
activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
|
||
referenced within the function.
|
||
|
||
We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
|
||
non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
|
||
a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
|
||
where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
|
||
|
||
Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
|
||
a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
|
||
where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
|
||
we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
|
||
declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
|
||
points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
|
||
|
||
In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
|
||
we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
|
||
because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
|
||
type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
|
||
if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
|
||
such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
|
||
`float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
|
||
`double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
|
||
output at debug-time.
|
||
|
||
So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
|
||
in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
|
||
are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
|
||
get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
|
||
not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
|
||
an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
|
||
when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
|
||
parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
|
||
TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
|
||
be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
|
||
passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
|
||
a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
|
||
the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
|
||
|
||
Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
|
||
parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
|
||
end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
|
||
as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
|
||
sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
|
||
debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
|
||
value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
|
||
rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
|
||
I'd like to fix it.
|
||
|
||
A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
|
||
any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
|
||
type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
|
||
to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
|
||
"active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
|
||
could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
|
||
sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
|
||
This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
|
||
parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
|
||
happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
|
||
DECL_INCOMING_RTL values, but integrate.c doesn't currently generate these
|
||
values for inlined instances of inline function parameters, so when we see
|
||
such cases, we are just out-of-luck for the time being (until integrate.c
|
||
gets fixed). */
|
||
|
||
/* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
|
||
rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
|
||
constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
|
||
fixed registers. */
|
||
if (! reload_completed)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtl
|
||
&& (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
|
||
&& CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (rtl) == REG
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
|
||
&& TREE_STATIC (decl))))
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
|
||
rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
|
||
#endif
|
||
return rtl;
|
||
}
|
||
rtl = NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
tree declared_type = type_main_variant (TREE_TYPE (decl));
|
||
tree passed_type = type_main_variant (DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl));
|
||
|
||
/* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
|
||
Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
|
||
all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
|
||
if (declared_type == passed_type)
|
||
rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
|
||
else if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (declared_type) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (declared_type))
|
||
<= GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (passed_type))))
|
||
rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
|
||
make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
|
||
parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
|
||
/* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
|
||
we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
|
||
of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
|
||
thing to do. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
|
||
&& XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
|
||
&& ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
|
||
/* Not passed in memory. */
|
||
&& GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)) != MEM
|
||
/* Not passed by invisible reference. */
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != REG
|
||
|| REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
#if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
|| REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
/* Big endian correction check. */
|
||
&& BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
&& TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
|
||
< UNITS_PER_WORD))
|
||
{
|
||
int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
|
||
- GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
|
||
|
||
rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
|
||
plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (rtl != NULL_RTX)
|
||
{
|
||
rtl = eliminate_regs (rtl, 0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
#ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
|
||
if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
|
||
leaf_renumber_regs_insn (rtl);
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
|
||
and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
|
||
C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
|
||
zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == STRING_CST
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
tree arrtype = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
||
tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (arrtype);
|
||
tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (arrtype);
|
||
tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
|
||
&& domain
|
||
&& integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
|
||
&& compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
|
||
TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
|
||
&& ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
|
||
== strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
|
||
rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init));
|
||
}
|
||
/* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
|
||
immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
|
||
tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == REAL_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
rtl = expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (decl), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
|
||
EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
|
||
/* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
|
||
if (rtl && GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
|
||
if (rtl)
|
||
rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
|
||
reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
|
||
code, and thus is not emitted. */
|
||
if (rtl)
|
||
rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
|
||
|
||
return rtl;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate *either* an DW_AT_location attribute or else an DW_AT_const_value
|
||
data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
|
||
DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
|
||
or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
|
||
register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
|
||
actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
|
||
these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
|
||
constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
|
||
pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
|
||
function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx rtl;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return;
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
|
||
if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
|
||
{
|
||
case ADDRESSOF:
|
||
/* The address of a variable that was optimized away;
|
||
don't emit anything. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_INT:
|
||
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
||
case CONST_STRING:
|
||
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
||
case LABEL_REF:
|
||
case CONST:
|
||
case PLUS:
|
||
/* DECL_RTL could be (plus (reg ...) (const_int ...)) */
|
||
add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MEM:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_THREAD_LOCAL (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Need loc_descriptor_from_tree since that's where we know
|
||
how to handle TLS variables. Want the object's address
|
||
since the top-level DW_AT_location assumes such. See
|
||
the confusion in loc_descriptor for reference. */
|
||
descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
case REG:
|
||
case SUBREG:
|
||
case CONCAT:
|
||
descr = loc_descriptor (rtl);
|
||
}
|
||
add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, descr);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
|
||
as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
|
||
we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref var_die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init
|
||
&& initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
|
||
/* OK */;
|
||
else
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case INTEGER_TYPE:
|
||
if (host_integerp (init, 0))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
tree_low_cst (init, 0));
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_long_long (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (init),
|
||
TREE_INT_CST_LOW (init));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate an DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
|
||
the value of the attribute. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_name_attribute (die, name_string)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
const char *name_string;
|
||
{
|
||
if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (demangle_name_func)
|
||
name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
|
||
|
||
add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
|
||
a representation for that bound. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound)
|
||
dw_die_ref subrange_die;
|
||
enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr;
|
||
tree bound;
|
||
{
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
|
||
case INTEGER_CST:
|
||
if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
|
||
|| (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
|
||
&& (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
|
||
|| (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
|
||
/* use the default */
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
case NOP_EXPR:
|
||
case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SAVE_EXPR:
|
||
/* If optimization is turned on, the SAVE_EXPRs that describe how to
|
||
access the upper bound values may be bogus. If they refer to a
|
||
register, they may only describe how to get at these values at the
|
||
points in the generated code right after they have just been
|
||
computed. Worse yet, in the typical case, the upper bound values
|
||
will not even *be* computed in the optimized code (though the
|
||
number of elements will), so these SAVE_EXPRs are entirely
|
||
bogus. In order to compensate for this fact, we check here to see
|
||
if optimization is enabled, and if so, we don't add an attribute
|
||
for the (unknown and unknowable) upper bound. This should not
|
||
cause too much trouble for existing (stupid?) debuggers because
|
||
they have to deal with empty upper bounds location descriptions
|
||
anyway in order to be able to deal with incomplete array types.
|
||
Of course an intelligent debugger (GDB?) should be able to
|
||
comprehend that a missing upper bound specification in an array
|
||
type used for a storage class `auto' local array variable
|
||
indicates that the upper bound is both unknown (at compile- time)
|
||
and unknowable (at run-time) due to optimization.
|
||
|
||
We assume that a MEM rtx is safe because gcc wouldn't put the
|
||
value there unless it was going to be used repeatedly in the
|
||
function, i.e. for cleanups. */
|
||
if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)
|
||
&& (! optimize || GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)) == MEM))
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
|
||
dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
|
||
rtx loc = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound);
|
||
|
||
/* If the RTL for the SAVE_EXPR is memory, handle the case where
|
||
it references an outer function's frame. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (loc) == MEM)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new_addr = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (loc, 0), bound);
|
||
|
||
if (XEXP (loc, 0) != new_addr)
|
||
loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (loc), new_addr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
|
||
add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location,
|
||
loc_descriptor (loc));
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Else leave out the attribute. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VAR_DECL:
|
||
case PARM_DECL:
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
|
||
first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
|
||
the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
|
||
the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
|
||
later parameter. */
|
||
if (decl_die != NULL)
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
{
|
||
/* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
|
||
evaluate the value of the array bound. */
|
||
|
||
dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
|
||
dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
|
||
|
||
loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound, 0);
|
||
if (loc == NULL)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (current_function_decl == 0)
|
||
ctx = comp_unit_die;
|
||
else
|
||
ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
|
||
|
||
/* If we weren't able to find a context, it's most likely the case
|
||
that we are processing the return type of the function. So
|
||
make a SAVE_EXPR to point to it and have the limbo DIE code
|
||
find the proper die. The save_expr function doesn't always
|
||
make a SAVE_EXPR, so do it ourselves. */
|
||
if (ctx == 0)
|
||
bound = build (SAVE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (bound), bound,
|
||
current_function_decl, NULL_TREE);
|
||
|
||
decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
|
||
add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
|
||
add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
|
||
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
|
||
includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_subscript_info (type_die, type)
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die;
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
unsigned dimension_number;
|
||
#endif
|
||
tree lower, upper;
|
||
dw_die_ref subrange_die;
|
||
|
||
/* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
|
||
one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
|
||
types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
|
||
type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
|
||
Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
|
||
compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
|
||
arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
|
||
(e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
|
||
|
||
/* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
|
||
const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
|
||
We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
|
||
gen_array_type_die. */
|
||
#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
for (dimension_number = 0;
|
||
TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
|
||
#endif
|
||
{
|
||
tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
|
||
|
||
/* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
|
||
and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
|
||
here. */
|
||
subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
|
||
if (domain)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
|
||
lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
|
||
upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
|
||
|
||
/* define the index type. */
|
||
if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
|
||
TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
|
||
because it is an unnamed integral type. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
|
||
type_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
|
||
but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
|
||
dimension arr(N:*)
|
||
Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
|
||
to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
|
||
bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
|
||
|
||
add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
|
||
if (upper)
|
||
add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
|
||
DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
|
||
bounds. */
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_byte_size_attribute (die, tree_node)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree tree_node;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned size;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
size = 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
|
||
break;
|
||
case FIELD_DECL:
|
||
/* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
|
||
generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
|
||
object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
|
||
even for bit-fields. */
|
||
size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
|
||
indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
|
||
have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
|
||
so just let the -1 pass on through. */
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
|
||
which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
|
||
"containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
|
||
bit-field itself.
|
||
|
||
For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
|
||
(of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
|
||
type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
|
||
declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
|
||
exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
|
||
complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
|
||
|
||
Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
|
||
which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
|
||
(See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_bit_offset_attribute (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
|
||
tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
|
||
|
||
/* Must be a field and a bit field. */
|
||
if (!type
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
|
||
encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
|
||
whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
|
||
if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
|
||
|| ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
|
||
highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
|
||
the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
|
||
is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
|
||
below must take account of these differences. */
|
||
highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
|
||
|
||
if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
{
|
||
highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
|
||
highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
bit_offset
|
||
= (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
|
||
: highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
|
||
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
|
||
which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_bit_size_attribute (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
/* Must be a field and a bit field. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL
|
||
|| ! DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
|
||
attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_prototyped_attribute (die, func_type)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree func_type;
|
||
{
|
||
if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
|
||
&& TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
|
||
add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
|
||
by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
|
||
equate table. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (die, origin)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree origin;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
|
||
function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
|
||
sure that the abstract function has been written out.
|
||
|
||
Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
|
||
distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
|
||
tree fn = origin;
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_P (fn))
|
||
fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
|
||
|
||
fn = decl_function_context (fn);
|
||
if (fn)
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_P (origin))
|
||
origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
|
||
else if (TYPE_P (origin))
|
||
origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
|
||
|
||
if (origin_die == NULL)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (die, func_decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree func_decl;
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
|
||
|
||
if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
|
||
add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
|
||
new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
|
||
tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
|
||
0));
|
||
|
||
/* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
|
||
lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
|
||
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add an DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
|
||
given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
tree decl_name;
|
||
|
||
decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
|
||
if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
|
||
if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
|
||
add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
|
||
|
||
if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
|
||
&& TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
|
||
&& DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
|
||
&& !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
|
||
IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
|
||
from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
|
||
XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
|
||
VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Push a new declaration scope. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
push_decl_scope (scope)
|
||
tree scope;
|
||
{
|
||
VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (decl_scope_table, scope);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pop a declaration scope. */
|
||
|
||
static inline void
|
||
pop_decl_scope ()
|
||
{
|
||
if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) <= 0)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
VARRAY_POP (decl_scope_table);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
|
||
Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
|
||
types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
|
||
otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
|
||
the current active scope. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
scope_die_for (t, context_die)
|
||
tree t;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
|
||
tree containing_scope;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
/* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
|
||
if (! TYPE_P (t))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore namespaces for the moment. */
|
||
if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
|
||
containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
|
||
a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
|
||
that isn't useful to DWARF. */
|
||
if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
|
||
containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
|
||
scope_die = comp_unit_die;
|
||
else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
|
||
{
|
||
/* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
|
||
first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
|
||
so we know where the new DIE should go. */
|
||
for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
|
||
if (VARRAY_TREE (decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (i < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
|
||
&& !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
|
||
scope_die = comp_unit_die;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
scope_die = context_die;
|
||
|
||
return scope_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
local_scope_p (context_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
|
||
if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
|
||
|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
class_scope_p (context_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
return (context_die
|
||
&& (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
|
||
|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
|
||
routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
|
||
by 'type', and adds an DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
add_type_attribute (object_die, type, decl_const, decl_volatile, context_die)
|
||
dw_die_ref object_die;
|
||
tree type;
|
||
int decl_const;
|
||
int decl_volatile;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
|
||
floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
|
||
support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
|
||
an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
|
||
if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
|
||
&& TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
|
||
|
||
if (code == ERROR_MARK
|
||
/* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
|
||
generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
|
||
`void', so this only applies to function return types). */
|
||
|| code == VOID_TYPE)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
type_die = modified_type_die (type,
|
||
decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
|
||
decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
|
||
context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (type_die != NULL)
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
|
||
a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
|
||
was declared without a tag. */
|
||
|
||
static const char *
|
||
type_tag (type)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
{
|
||
const char *name = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
tree t = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
|
||
t = TYPE_NAME (type);
|
||
|
||
/* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
|
||
a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
|
||
involved. */
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
|
||
&& ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
|
||
t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
|
||
|
||
/* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
|
||
if (t != 0)
|
||
name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
|
||
for bit field types. */
|
||
|
||
static inline tree
|
||
member_declared_type (member)
|
||
tree member;
|
||
{
|
||
return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
|
||
? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
|
||
from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static const char *
|
||
decl_start_label (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
rtx x;
|
||
const char *fnname;
|
||
|
||
x = DECL_RTL (decl);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
x = XEXP (x, 0);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
|
||
return fnname;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
|
||
the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
|
||
the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_array_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
|
||
dw_die_ref array_die;
|
||
tree element_type;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
|
||
the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
|
||
call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
|
||
add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
/* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
|
||
containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
|
||
add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
|
||
the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
|
||
an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
|
||
SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
|
||
then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
|
||
and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
|
||
for multidimensional arrays. */
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
|
||
AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
|
||
if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
#endif
|
||
add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
|
||
|
||
/* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
|
||
element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
|
||
const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
|
||
We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
|
||
add_subscript_info. */
|
||
#ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
|
||
element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
|
||
|
||
gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_set_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_set_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
|
||
add_type_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_entry_point_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
|
||
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
|
||
add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
|
||
0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
|
||
emit full debugging info for them. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
retry_incomplete_types ()
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
||
gen_type_die (VARRAY_TREE (incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
|
||
|
||
/* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
|
||
be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
|
||
|
||
/* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
|
||
be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
|
||
|
||
/* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
|
||
be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
|
||
include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
|
||
enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
|
||
DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
|
||
|
||
if (type_die == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
|
||
scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
|
||
add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
|
||
}
|
||
else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
|
||
return;
|
||
else
|
||
remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
|
||
|
||
/* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
|
||
given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
|
||
attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
|
||
if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
tree link;
|
||
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
|
||
add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
|
||
if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
|
||
add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
|
||
|
||
/* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
|
||
inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
|
||
if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
|
||
add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
|
||
|
||
for (link = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
|
||
link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
|
||
|
||
add_name_attribute (enum_die,
|
||
IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
|
||
|
||
if (host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (link),
|
||
TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (link)))))
|
||
{
|
||
if (tree_int_cst_sgn (TREE_VALUE (link)) < 0)
|
||
add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
|
||
tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 1));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
|
||
represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
|
||
type.
|
||
|
||
Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
|
||
..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
|
||
represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
|
||
node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
|
||
DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
|
||
it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
|
||
DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
|
||
argument type of some subprogram type. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
gen_formal_parameter_die (node, context_die)
|
||
tree node;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref parm_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
|
||
tree origin;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
|
||
{
|
||
case 'd':
|
||
origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
|
||
add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
|
||
TREE_READONLY (node),
|
||
TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
|
||
context_die);
|
||
if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
|
||
add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
|
||
if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
|
||
add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node);
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case 't':
|
||
/* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
|
||
add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return parm_die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
|
||
at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl_or_type, context_die)
|
||
tree decl_or_type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
|
||
DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
|
||
parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
|
||
those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_formal_types_die (function_or_method_type, context_die)
|
||
tree function_or_method_type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree link;
|
||
tree formal_type = NULL;
|
||
tree first_parm_type;
|
||
tree arg;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
|
||
function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
arg = NULL_TREE;
|
||
|
||
first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
|
||
|
||
/* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
|
||
DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
|
||
for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref parm_die;
|
||
|
||
formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
|
||
if (formal_type == void_type_node)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
|
||
parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
|
||
if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
|
||
&& link == first_parm_type)
|
||
|| (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
|
||
add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
|
||
link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
|
||
if (arg)
|
||
arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
|
||
DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
|
||
if (formal_type != void_type_node)
|
||
gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
|
||
and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
|
||
for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
|
||
link && TREE_VALUE (link);
|
||
link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
|
||
die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
|
||
to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
|
||
generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
|
||
trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_type_die_for_member (type, member, context_die)
|
||
tree type, member;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
gen_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
|
||
emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
|
||
if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
|
||
&& ! lookup_decl_die (member))
|
||
{
|
||
if (decl_ultimate_origin (member))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
push_decl_scope (type);
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
gen_subprogram_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
|
||
else
|
||
gen_variable_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
|
||
|
||
pop_decl_scope ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
|
||
may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref old_die;
|
||
tree save_fn;
|
||
tree context;
|
||
int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
|
||
decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
|
||
|
||
old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
|
||
if (old_die && get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
|
||
/* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
|
||
we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
{
|
||
context = decl_class_context (decl);
|
||
if (context)
|
||
gen_type_die_for_member
|
||
(context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
|
||
save_fn = current_function_decl;
|
||
current_function_decl = decl;
|
||
|
||
set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
|
||
dwarf2out_decl (decl);
|
||
if (! was_abstract)
|
||
set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
|
||
|
||
current_function_decl = save_fn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
|
||
block-local). */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
dw_die_ref subr_die;
|
||
rtx fp_reg;
|
||
tree fn_arg_types;
|
||
tree outer_scope;
|
||
dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
|
||
int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
|
||
|| class_scope_p (context_die));
|
||
|
||
/* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
|
||
started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
|
||
its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
|
||
from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
|
||
we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
|
||
|
||
/* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
|
||
if (origin && declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
|
||
{
|
||
origin = NULL;
|
||
if (old_die)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (declaration && ! local_scope_p (context_die))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
|
||
inline function. */
|
||
if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
|
||
add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
|
||
|
||
subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (old_die)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
|
||
|
||
if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
|
||
/* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
|
||
case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
|
||
It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
|
||
&& !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? This can happen if there is a bug in the program, for
|
||
instance, if it has duplicate function definitions. Ideally,
|
||
we should detect this case and ignore it. For now, if we have
|
||
already reported an error, any error at all, then assume that
|
||
we got here because of an input error, not a dwarf2 bug. */
|
||
if (errorcount)
|
||
return;
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
|
||
maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
|
||
that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
|
||
debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
|
||
instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
|
||
to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
|
||
apply; we just use the old DIE. */
|
||
if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
|
||
&& (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
|
||
|| (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
|
||
&& (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
|
||
== (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl)))))
|
||
{
|
||
subr_die = old_die;
|
||
|
||
/* Clear out the declaration attribute and the parm types. */
|
||
remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
|
||
remove_children (subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
|
||
if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
|
||
if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
|
||
!= (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned
|
||
(subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
|
||
add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
|
||
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
{
|
||
add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
|
||
add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
|
||
0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
|
||
if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
|
||
add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
|
||
else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (declaration)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
|
||
the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
|
||
the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
|
||
handled above. The two may come from the same source text. */
|
||
if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && !flag_no_inline)
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? Checking DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT is correct for static
|
||
inline functions, but not for extern inline functions.
|
||
We can't get this completely correct because information
|
||
about whether the function was declared inline is not
|
||
saved anywhere. */
|
||
if (DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
|
||
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
|
||
current_function_funcdef_no);
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
|
||
current_function_funcdef_no);
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
|
||
|
||
add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
|
||
add_arange (decl, subr_die);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
|
||
add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Define the "frame base" location for this routine. We use the
|
||
frame pointer or stack pointer registers, since the RTL for local
|
||
variables is relative to one of them. */
|
||
fp_reg
|
||
= frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx : stack_pointer_rtx;
|
||
add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, reg_loc_descriptor (fp_reg));
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* ??? This fails for nested inline functions, because context_display
|
||
is not part of the state saved/restored for inline functions. */
|
||
if (current_function_needs_context)
|
||
add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
|
||
loc_descriptor (lookup_static_chain (decl)));
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
|
||
(unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
|
||
for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
|
||
`...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
|
||
there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
|
||
associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
|
||
FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
|
||
FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
|
||
an ellipsis at the end. */
|
||
|
||
/* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
|
||
need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
|
||
its formal parameters. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
;
|
||
else if (declaration)
|
||
gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters */
|
||
tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
|
||
tree parm;
|
||
|
||
/* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
|
||
instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
|
||
for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_NAME (parm)
|
||
&& !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
|
||
"__builtin_va_alist"))
|
||
gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
|
||
There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
|
||
this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
|
||
void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
|
||
definition). This just means that we have no info about the
|
||
parameters at all. */
|
||
fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
|
||
if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* this is the prototyped case, check for ... */
|
||
if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
|
||
gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
|
||
gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
|
||
(if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
|
||
outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
|
||
a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
|
||
for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
|
||
parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
|
||
end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
|
||
the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
|
||
DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
|
||
|
||
The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
|
||
the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
|
||
for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
|
||
a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
|
||
and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
|
||
constructor function. */
|
||
if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
|
||
{
|
||
current_function_has_inlines = 0;
|
||
decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
|
||
|
||
#if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
|
||
if (current_function_has_inlines)
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
|
||
if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
|
||
comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_variable_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
|
||
|
||
dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
|
||
int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
|
||
|| class_scope_p (context_die));
|
||
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
|
||
|
||
/* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
|
||
static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
|
||
|
||
??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
|
||
copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
|
||
sharing them.
|
||
|
||
??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
|
||
else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl)
|
||
&& get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (var_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
|
||
if (DECL_NAME (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
|
||
|
||
if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
|
||
|
||
if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
|
||
!= (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
|
||
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line,
|
||
DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
|
||
add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
|
||
TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
|
||
add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
|
||
add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
|
||
else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (declaration)
|
||
add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (class_scope_p (context_die) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
|
||
|
||
if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
|
||
add_pubname (decl, var_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_label_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
|
||
else
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
insn = DECL_RTL (decl);
|
||
|
||
/* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
|
||
eliminated because of various optimisations. We still emit them
|
||
here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL
|
||
|| ((GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
|
||
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
|
||
(e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
|
||
represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
|
||
the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
|
||
it if it ever does happen. */
|
||
if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
|
||
tree stmt;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
int depth;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
|
||
char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
|
||
{
|
||
if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
|
||
{
|
||
tree chain;
|
||
|
||
add_AT_range_list (stmt_die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
|
||
|
||
chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
|
||
do
|
||
{
|
||
add_ranges (chain);
|
||
chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
|
||
}
|
||
while (chain);
|
||
add_ranges (NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
|
||
BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
|
||
BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
|
||
tree stmt;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
int depth;
|
||
{
|
||
if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref subr_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
|
||
tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
|
||
char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
|
||
|
||
/* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. */
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
|
||
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
|
||
BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
|
||
BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
|
||
decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
|
||
current_function_has_inlines = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
/* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
|
||
inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
|
||
generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
|
||
would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
|
||
So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
|
||
for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
|
||
declarations within the block. This is particularly important
|
||
in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
|
||
if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
|
||
wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
|
||
when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
|
||
intended :-) */
|
||
gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_field_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref decl_die;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
|
||
add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
|
||
TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
|
||
context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
|
||
add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
|
||
add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
|
||
add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
|
||
add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
|
||
else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#if 0
|
||
/* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
|
||
Use modified_type_die instead.
|
||
We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
|
||
represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_pointer_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref ptr_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
|
||
add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
|
||
Use modified_type_die instead.
|
||
We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
|
||
represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_reference_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref ref_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
|
||
add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref ptr_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
|
||
scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
|
||
lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
|
||
add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
|
||
|
||
static dw_die_ref
|
||
gen_compile_unit_die (filename)
|
||
const char *filename;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
char producer[250];
|
||
const char *wd = getpwd ();
|
||
const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
|
||
int language;
|
||
|
||
die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
|
||
add_name_attribute (die, filename);
|
||
|
||
if (wd != NULL && filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
|
||
add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
|
||
|
||
sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
|
||
/* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
|
||
string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
|
||
not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
|
||
that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
|
||
To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
|
||
information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
strcat (producer, " -g");
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
|
||
|
||
if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
|
||
language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
|
||
else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
|
||
language = DW_LANG_Ada83;
|
||
else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
|
||
language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
|
||
else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
|
||
language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
|
||
else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
|
||
language = DW_LANG_Java;
|
||
else
|
||
language = DW_LANG_C89;
|
||
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
|
||
return die;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a string type. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_string_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Fudge the string length attribute for now.
|
||
TODO: add string length info. */
|
||
#if 0
|
||
string_length_attribute (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
|
||
bound_representation (upper_bound, 0, 'u');
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_inheritance_die (binfo, context_die)
|
||
tree binfo;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
|
||
|
||
add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (binfo))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_VIA_PUBLIC (binfo))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
|
||
else if (TREE_VIA_PROTECTED (binfo))
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_member_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree member;
|
||
dw_die_ref child;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
|
||
members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
|
||
members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
|
||
DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
|
||
function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
|
||
types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
|
||
for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
|
||
members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
|
||
force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
|
||
type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
|
||
the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
|
||
|
||
/* First output info about the base classes. */
|
||
if (TYPE_BINFO (type) && TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type))
|
||
{
|
||
tree bases = TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type);
|
||
int n_bases = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (bases);
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_bases; i++)
|
||
gen_inheritance_die (TREE_VEC_ELT (bases, i), context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
|
||
for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
|
||
and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
|
||
may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
|
||
do put them in the right order. */
|
||
|
||
child = lookup_decl_die (member);
|
||
if (child)
|
||
splice_child_die (context_die, child);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
|
||
for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Don't include clones in the member list. */
|
||
if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
child = lookup_decl_die (member);
|
||
if (child)
|
||
splice_child_die (context_die, child);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
|
||
is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
|
||
member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
|
||
dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
|
||
int nested = 0;
|
||
int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
|
||
&& (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
|
||
|| ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
|
||
|
||
if (type_die && ! complete)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
|
||
&& AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
|
||
nested = 1;
|
||
|
||
scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
|
||
/* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
|
||
|
||
type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
|
||
? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
|
||
scope_die, type);
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
|
||
if (old_die)
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
|
||
else
|
||
add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
|
||
|
||
/* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
|
||
then give a list of members. */
|
||
if (complete)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
|
||
this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
|
||
add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
|
||
if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
|
||
add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
|
||
|
||
/* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
|
||
inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
|
||
if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
|
||
add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
|
||
|
||
push_decl_scope (type);
|
||
gen_member_die (type, type_die);
|
||
pop_decl_scope ();
|
||
|
||
/* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
|
||
if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
|
||
{
|
||
tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
|
||
|
||
gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
|
||
add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
|
||
lookup_type_die (vtype));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
|
||
if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
|
||
&& ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
|
||
VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (incomplete_types, type);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
dw_die_ref subr_die
|
||
= new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
|
||
scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
|
||
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
|
||
add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
|
||
add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
|
||
gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a type definition */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref type_die;
|
||
tree origin;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
|
||
type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
|
||
origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
if (origin != NULL)
|
||
add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
tree type;
|
||
|
||
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
|
||
if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
|
||
|
||
if (type == TREE_TYPE (decl))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
else
|
||
equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
||
|
||
add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
|
||
TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
|
||
equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a type description DIE. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_type_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
int need_pop;
|
||
|
||
if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
|
||
&& DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
|
||
if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == type)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
|
||
gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
|
||
of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
|
||
get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
|
||
now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
|
||
cloned type itself). */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
|
||
type = type_main_variant (type);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case POINTER_TYPE:
|
||
case REFERENCE_TYPE:
|
||
/* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
|
||
ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
|
||
type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
|
||
/* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
|
||
statement. */
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
|
||
set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case OFFSET_TYPE:
|
||
/* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
|
||
Output a description of the relevant class type. */
|
||
gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
|
||
itself. */
|
||
gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case SET_TYPE:
|
||
gen_type_die (TYPE_DOMAIN (type), context_die);
|
||
gen_set_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FILE_TYPE:
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
abort (); /* No way to represent these in Dwarf yet! */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FUNCTION_TYPE:
|
||
/* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case METHOD_TYPE:
|
||
/* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ARRAY_TYPE:
|
||
if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == CHAR_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
|
||
gen_string_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VECTOR_TYPE:
|
||
gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
/* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
|
||
out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
|
||
to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
|
||
the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
|
||
idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
|
||
what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
|
||
if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
|
||
&& AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
|
||
&& ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
|
||
{
|
||
gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
|
||
push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
|
||
context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
|
||
need_pop = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
need_pop = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
|
||
gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
|
||
if (need_pop)
|
||
pop_decl_scope ();
|
||
|
||
/* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
|
||
it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
|
||
when appropriate. */
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case VOID_TYPE:
|
||
case INTEGER_TYPE:
|
||
case REAL_TYPE:
|
||
case COMPLEX_TYPE:
|
||
case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
|
||
case CHAR_TYPE:
|
||
/* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LANG_TYPE:
|
||
/* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (type, context_die)
|
||
tree type;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
|
||
this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
|
||
that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
|
||
type now. */
|
||
if (type != type_main_variant (type))
|
||
abort ();
|
||
|
||
/* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
|
||
an instance of an unresolved type. */
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
|
||
gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
|
||
things which are local to the given block. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
|
||
tree stmt;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
int depth;
|
||
{
|
||
int must_output_die = 0;
|
||
tree origin;
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
enum tree_code origin_code;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
|
||
if (stmt == NULL_TREE || !TREE_USED (stmt)
|
||
|| (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt) && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
|
||
process the variables, since they will have been done by the
|
||
origin block. Do process subblocks. */
|
||
if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
|
||
{
|
||
tree sub;
|
||
|
||
for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
|
||
gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
|
||
inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
|
||
to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
|
||
sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
|
||
the current block. */
|
||
origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
|
||
origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
|
||
|
||
/* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
|
||
block. */
|
||
if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
/* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
|
||
generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
|
||
must_output_die = 1;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
|
||
"body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
|
||
this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
|
||
inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
|
||
really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
|
||
check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
|
||
block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
|
||
if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
|
||
local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
/* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
|
||
as being a "significant" one. */
|
||
must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL);
|
||
else
|
||
/* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
|
||
definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
|
||
for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
|
||
decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
|
||
&& DECL_INITIAL (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
must_output_die = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
|
||
DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
|
||
all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
|
||
needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
|
||
that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
|
||
local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
|
||
instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
|
||
if (must_output_die)
|
||
{
|
||
if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
|
||
all of its sub-blocks. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth)
|
||
tree stmt;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
int depth;
|
||
{
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
tree subblocks;
|
||
|
||
/* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
|
||
if (stmt == NULL_TREE || ! TREE_USED (stmt))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
|
||
declared directly within this block but not within any nested
|
||
sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
|
||
generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
|
||
for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref die;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
|
||
die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
|
||
else
|
||
die = NULL;
|
||
|
||
if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
|
||
add_child_die (context_die, die);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
|
||
therein) of this block. */
|
||
for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
|
||
subblocks != NULL;
|
||
subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
|
||
gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
|
||
|
||
static inline int
|
||
is_redundant_typedef (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
|
||
&& DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
|
||
&& is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
|
||
&& DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
|
||
/* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
gen_decl_die (decl, context_die)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die;
|
||
{
|
||
tree origin;
|
||
|
||
if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CONST_DECL:
|
||
/* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
|
||
the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FUNCTION_DECL:
|
||
/* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
|
||
unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
|
||
if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
|
||
&& (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
|
||
if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
|
||
|
||
/* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
|
||
emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
|
||
else if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
|
||
&& ! class_scope_p (context_die)
|
||
/* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
|
||
a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
|
||
that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
|
||
&& DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
|
||
{
|
||
dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
|
||
set_decl_origin_self (decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
|
||
else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
|
||
have described its return type. */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* And its virtual context. */
|
||
if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
|
||
gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* And its containing type. */
|
||
origin = decl_class_context (decl);
|
||
if (origin != NULL_TREE)
|
||
gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
|
||
gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TYPE_DECL:
|
||
/* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
|
||
actual typedefs. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
|
||
of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
|
||
instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
|
||
was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
|
||
have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
|
||
DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
|
||
if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
|
||
{
|
||
gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
|
||
else
|
||
/* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
|
||
gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case LABEL_DECL:
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
|
||
gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VAR_DECL:
|
||
/* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
|
||
variable declarations or definitions. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
/* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
|
||
object. */
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* And its containing type. */
|
||
origin = decl_class_context (decl);
|
||
if (origin != NULL_TREE)
|
||
gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
|
||
complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
|
||
represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
|
||
function. */
|
||
origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
|
||
if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
|
||
gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
else
|
||
gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case FIELD_DECL:
|
||
/* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
|
||
anonymous unions. */
|
||
if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
|
||
gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PARM_DECL:
|
||
gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
|
||
gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NAMESPACE_DECL:
|
||
/* Ignore for now. */
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
mark_limbo_die_list (ptr)
|
||
void *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
limbo_die_node *node;
|
||
for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
|
||
ggc_mark_tree (node->created_for);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (filename, context_list)
|
||
const char *filename;
|
||
const char *context_list;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int file_index;
|
||
|
||
if (filename != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
|
||
tree context_list_decl
|
||
= build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
|
||
void_type_node);
|
||
|
||
TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
|
||
add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
|
||
file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
|
||
add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
|
||
add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
|
||
compilation proper has finished. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_global_decl (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
/* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
|
||
declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
|
||
corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
|
||
definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
|
||
dwarf2out_decl (decl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
dwarf2out_decl (decl)
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
|
||
{
|
||
case ERROR_MARK:
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
case FUNCTION_DECL:
|
||
/* Ignore this FUNCTION_DECL if it refers to a builtin declaration of a
|
||
builtin function. Explicit programmer-supplied declarations of
|
||
these same functions should NOT be ignored however. */
|
||
if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && DECL_BUILT_IN (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
|
||
file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
|
||
referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
|
||
that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
|
||
no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
|
||
on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
|
||
file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
|
||
and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
|
||
it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
|
||
with the definition of the function.
|
||
|
||
We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
|
||
nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
|
||
declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
|
||
the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
|
||
function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
|
||
translation unit (an thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
|
||
abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
|
||
instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
|
||
generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
|
||
that they *are* definitions).
|
||
|
||
The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
|
||
inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
|
||
them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
|
||
for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
|
||
also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
|
||
if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
|
||
a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
|
||
we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
|
||
if (decl_function_context (decl)
|
||
/* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
|
||
&& debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
context_die = NULL;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VAR_DECL:
|
||
/* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
|
||
declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
|
||
within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
|
||
order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
|
||
which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
|
||
block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
|
||
would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
|
||
miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
|
||
if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
|
||
variable declarations or definitions. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
return;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case TYPE_DECL:
|
||
/* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
|
||
if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
|
||
normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
|
||
if (DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
|
||
comparisons have. */
|
||
if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
|
||
== DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
|
||
&& ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
|
||
modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
|
||
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
|
||
this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
|
||
if (decl_function_context (decl))
|
||
context_die = NULL;
|
||
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
|
||
a lexical block. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_begin_block (line, blocknum)
|
||
unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
unsigned int blocknum;
|
||
{
|
||
function_section (current_function_decl);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
|
||
lexical block. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_end_block (line, blocknum)
|
||
unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
unsigned int blocknum;
|
||
{
|
||
function_section (current_function_decl);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
|
||
information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
|
||
|
||
Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
|
||
as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
|
||
we may end up calling them anyway. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
dwarf2out_ignore_block (block)
|
||
tree block;
|
||
{
|
||
tree decl;
|
||
|
||
for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
|
||
|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
|
||
dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
|
||
just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
|
||
need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
|
||
section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
|
||
and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
|
||
found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
|
||
available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
|
||
the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
|
||
all searches. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned
|
||
lookup_filename (file_name)
|
||
const char *file_name;
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned i;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Why isn't DECL_SOURCE_FILE left null instead. */
|
||
if (strcmp (file_name, "<internal>") == 0
|
||
|| strcmp (file_name, "<built-in>") == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
|
||
call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
|
||
if (file_table.last_lookup_index != 0)
|
||
if (0 == strcmp (file_name,
|
||
file_table.table[file_table.last_lookup_index]))
|
||
return file_table.last_lookup_index;
|
||
|
||
/* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table */
|
||
for (i = 1; i < file_table.in_use; i++)
|
||
if (strcmp (file_name, file_table.table[i]) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
|
||
return i;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Prepare to add a new table entry by making sure there is enough space in
|
||
the table to do so. If not, expand the current table. */
|
||
if (i == file_table.allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
file_table.allocated = i + FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
file_table.table = (char **)
|
||
xrealloc (file_table.table, file_table.allocated * sizeof (char *));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
|
||
file_table.table[i] = xstrdup (file_name);
|
||
file_table.in_use = i + 1;
|
||
file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
|
||
|
||
if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
|
||
{
|
||
fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", i);
|
||
output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, file_name);
|
||
fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return i;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
init_file_table ()
|
||
{
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
|
||
file_table.table = (char **) xcalloc (FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (char *));
|
||
file_table.allocated = FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
|
||
file_table.in_use = 1;
|
||
file_table.last_lookup_index = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
|
||
and record information relating to this source line, in
|
||
'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_source_line (line, filename)
|
||
unsigned int line;
|
||
const char *filename;
|
||
{
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
|
||
{
|
||
function_section (current_function_decl);
|
||
|
||
/* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
|
||
if (flag_debug_asm)
|
||
fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
|
||
filename, line);
|
||
|
||
if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
|
||
|
||
/* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
|
||
fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
|
||
|
||
/* Indicate that line number info exists. */
|
||
line_info_table_in_use++;
|
||
|
||
/* Indicate that multiple line number tables exist. */
|
||
if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
|
||
separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
|
||
{
|
||
dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
|
||
separate_line_info_table_in_use);
|
||
|
||
/* expand the line info table if necessary */
|
||
if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
|
||
== separate_line_info_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
separate_line_info_table
|
||
= (dw_separate_line_info_ref)
|
||
xrealloc (separate_line_info_table,
|
||
separate_line_info_table_allocated
|
||
* sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
|
||
line_info
|
||
= &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
|
||
line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
|
||
line_info->dw_line_num = line;
|
||
line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
dw_line_info_ref line_info;
|
||
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
|
||
line_info_table_in_use);
|
||
|
||
/* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
|
||
if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
|
||
{
|
||
line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
line_info_table
|
||
= (dw_line_info_ref)
|
||
xrealloc (line_info_table,
|
||
(line_info_table_allocated
|
||
* sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
|
||
line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
|
||
line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
|
||
line_info->dw_line_num = line;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_start_source_file (lineno, filename)
|
||
unsigned int lineno;
|
||
const char *filename;
|
||
{
|
||
if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && !is_main_source)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
|
||
dw_die_ref bincl_die;
|
||
|
||
bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
|
||
add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
is_main_source = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
|
||
lineno);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lookup_filename (filename),
|
||
"Filename we just started");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Record the end of a source file. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_end_source_file (lineno)
|
||
unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
|
||
/* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
|
||
new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
|
||
the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
|
||
initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_define (lineno, buffer)
|
||
unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
|
||
the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
|
||
initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_undef (lineno, buffer)
|
||
unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_init (main_input_filename)
|
||
const char *main_input_filename;
|
||
{
|
||
init_file_table ();
|
||
|
||
/* Remember the name of the primary input file. */
|
||
primary_filename = main_input_filename;
|
||
|
||
/* Add it to the file table first, under the assumption that we'll
|
||
be emitting line number data for it first, which avoids having
|
||
to add an initial DW_LNS_set_file. */
|
||
lookup_filename (main_input_filename);
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_die_table. */
|
||
decl_die_table
|
||
= (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_die_ref));
|
||
decl_die_table_allocated = DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
decl_die_table_in_use = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
|
||
VARRAY_TREE_INIT (decl_scope_table, 256, "decl_scope_table");
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
|
||
abbrev_die_table
|
||
= (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT,
|
||
sizeof (dw_die_ref));
|
||
abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
/* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
|
||
abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
|
||
line_info_table
|
||
= (dw_line_info_ref) xcalloc (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT,
|
||
sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
|
||
line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
|
||
|
||
/* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
|
||
line_info_table_in_use = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
|
||
value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
|
||
will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
|
||
taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
|
||
invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. */
|
||
comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (main_input_filename);
|
||
is_main_source = 1;
|
||
|
||
VARRAY_TREE_INIT (incomplete_types, 64, "incomplete_types");
|
||
|
||
VARRAY_RTX_INIT (used_rtx_varray, 32, "used_rtx_varray");
|
||
|
||
ggc_add_root (&limbo_die_list, 1, 1, mark_limbo_die_list);
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
strcpy (text_section_label, stripattributes (TEXT_SECTION_NAME));
|
||
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
|
||
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
|
||
{
|
||
text_section ();
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Allocate a string in .debug_str hash table. */
|
||
|
||
static hashnode
|
||
indirect_string_alloc (tab)
|
||
hash_table *tab ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
struct indirect_string_node *node;
|
||
|
||
node = xmalloc (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
|
||
node->refcount = 0;
|
||
node->form = 0;
|
||
node->label = NULL;
|
||
|
||
return (hashnode) node;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
|
||
ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
output_indirect_string (pfile, h, v)
|
||
struct cpp_reader *pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
hashnode h;
|
||
const PTR v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) h;
|
||
|
||
if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_STR_SECTION, DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
|
||
assemble_string ((const char *) HT_STR (&node->id),
|
||
HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
|
||
and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
dwarf2out_finish (input_filename)
|
||
const char *input_filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
||
{
|
||
limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
|
||
dw_die_ref die = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
|
||
dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
|
||
inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
|
||
For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
|
||
instance. */
|
||
for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
|
||
{
|
||
next_node = node->next;
|
||
die = node->die;
|
||
|
||
if (die->die_parent == NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
|
||
tree context;
|
||
|
||
if (origin)
|
||
add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
|
||
else if (die == comp_unit_die)
|
||
;
|
||
/* If this was an expression for a bound involved in a function
|
||
return type, it may be a SAVE_EXPR for which we weren't able
|
||
to find a DIE previously. So try now. */
|
||
else if (node->created_for
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (node->created_for) == SAVE_EXPR
|
||
&& 0 != (origin = (lookup_decl_die
|
||
(SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT
|
||
(node->created_for)))))
|
||
add_child_die (origin, die);
|
||
else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
|
||
/* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
|
||
add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
|
||
else if (node->created_for
|
||
&& ((DECL_P (node->created_for)
|
||
&& (context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for)))
|
||
|| (TYPE_P (node->created_for)
|
||
&& (context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for))))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
/* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
|
||
nested function can be optimized away, which results
|
||
in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
|
||
with the return type of that nested function. Force
|
||
this to be a child of the containing function. */
|
||
origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
|
||
if (! origin)
|
||
abort ();
|
||
add_child_die (origin, die);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
abort ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
free (node);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
limbo_die_list = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
|
||
emit full debugging info for them. */
|
||
retry_incomplete_types ();
|
||
|
||
/* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
|
||
we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
|
||
reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
|
||
They will go into limbo_die_list. */
|
||
if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
|
||
break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
|
||
|
||
/* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
|
||
that have children. */
|
||
add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
|
||
for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
|
||
add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
|
||
|
||
/* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
|
||
text_section ();
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
|
||
even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
|
||
translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
|
||
.debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
|
||
examining the file. */
|
||
if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
output_line_info ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output location list section if necessary. */
|
||
if (have_location_lists)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Output the location lists info. */
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
|
||
DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
|
||
output_location_lists (die);
|
||
have_location_lists = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
|
||
in .text. */
|
||
if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
|
||
add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
|
||
"base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
|
||
else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
|
||
add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
|
||
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
|
||
add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
|
||
debug_line_section_label);
|
||
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
|
||
|
||
/* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
|
||
the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
|
||
for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
|
||
output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
|
||
|
||
output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Output the abbreviation table. */
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
output_abbrev_section ();
|
||
|
||
/* Output public names table if necessary. */
|
||
if (pubname_table_in_use)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
output_pubnames ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
|
||
table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
|
||
if (fde_table_in_use)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
output_aranges ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Output ranges section if necessary. */
|
||
if (ranges_table_in_use)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
|
||
output_ranges ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Have to end the primary source file. */
|
||
if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
|
||
{
|
||
named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
|
||
dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
|
||
table too. */
|
||
if (debug_str_hash)
|
||
ht_forall (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
|
||
}
|
||
#else
|
||
|
||
/* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
|
||
const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
|
||
|
||
#endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
|
||
|
||
#include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
|